blob: 3853d406f8484b60f1282396bccb50f6c5d09d2e [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaud0089302020-04-17 14:19:38 +02007 2020/04/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
574. Proxies
584.1. Proxy keywords matrix
594.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
60
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100615. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200625.1. Bind options
635.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200645.3. Server DNS resolution
655.3.1. Global overview
665.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020067
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100686. Cache
696.1. Limitation
706.2. Setup
716.2.1. Cache section
726.2.2. Proxy section
73
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200747. Using ACLs and fetching samples
757.1. ACL basics
767.1.1. Matching booleans
777.1.2. Matching integers
787.1.3. Matching strings
797.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
807.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
817.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
827.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
837.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200847.3.1. Converters
857.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
867.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
877.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
887.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
897.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Fauletba3c68f2020-04-01 16:27:05 +0200907.3.7. Fetching health-check samples
917.3.8. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200927.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093
948. Logging
958.1. Log levels
968.2. Log formats
978.2.1. Default log format
988.2.2. TCP log format
998.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001008.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001018.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001028.3. Advanced logging options
1038.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1048.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1058.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1068.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1078.4. Timing events
1088.5. Session state at disconnection
1098.6. Non-printable characters
1108.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1118.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1128.9. Examples of logs
113
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001149. Supported filters
1159.1. Trace
1169.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001179.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001189.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001199.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200120
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012110. FastCGI applications
12210.1. Setup
12310.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12410.1.2. Proxy section
12510.1.3. Example
12610.2. Default parameters
12710.3. Limitations
128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129
1301. Quick reminder about HTTP
131----------------------------
132
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
135on almost anything found in the contents.
136
137However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
138formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
139correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
140
141
1421.1. The HTTP transaction model
143-------------------------------
144
145The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100146to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100147from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
148connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149will involve a new connection :
150
151 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
152
153In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
154establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
155by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
156length.
157
158Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
159to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
160however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
161response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
162header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
167power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
168but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100171Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
173second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
174page :
175
176 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
177
178This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
179latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
180correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
181the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100182server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100184The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
185time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
186are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
187parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
188carry the stream identifier.
189
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
191connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
192leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100193start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
194processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
195waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200196
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200197HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
199 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100200 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100201 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200202 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100203
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100204For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
205the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100206server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
207is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
208servers.
209
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210
2111.2. HTTP request
212-----------------
213
214First, let's consider this HTTP request :
215
216 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100217 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
219 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
220 3 User-agent: my small browser
221 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
222 5 Accept: image/png
223
224
2251.2.1. The Request line
226-----------------------
227
228Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
229
230 - a METHOD : GET
231 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
232 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
233
234All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
235which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
236followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
237is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
238desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
239the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
240
241The URI itself can have several forms :
242
243 - A "relative URI" :
244
245 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
246
247 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
248 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
249
250 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
251
252 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
253
254 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
255 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
256 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
257 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
258 must accept this form too.
259
260 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
261 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
262 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100263
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200264 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
265 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
266 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
267 other protocols too.
268
269In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
270mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
271on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
272It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
273specific to the language, framework or application in use.
274
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100275HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100276assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
278received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
279processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
280as well as in server logs.
281
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200282
2831.2.2. The request headers
284--------------------------
285
286The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
287beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
288an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
289Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
290values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
291encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
292the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
293define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
294
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100295Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200296their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100297"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
298as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299
300The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
301that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
302is one valid form of empty line.
303
304Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
305headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
306about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
307application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
308
309Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000310 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200311 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
312 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
313 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
314
315
3161.3. HTTP response
317------------------
318
319An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
320messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
321
322 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100323 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200324 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
325 2 Content-length: 350
326 3 Content-Type: text/html
327
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200328As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
329codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
330response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100331continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
332the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
333following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
334sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
335(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
336correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
337such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
338state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
339over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
340if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
341information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200343
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003441.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345------------------------
346
347Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
348
349 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
350 - a status code : 200
351 - a reason : OK
352
353The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
355 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
356 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
357 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
358 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000360Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100361"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
363messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
364or "Authentication Required".
365
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100366HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200367
368 Code When / reason
369 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
370 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100373 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 400 for an invalid or too large request
376 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
377 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200378 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100379 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200380 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100381 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
382 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200383 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
384 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
385 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200386 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200387 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
388 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
389 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
390
391The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3924.2).
393
394
3951.3.2. The response headers
396---------------------------
397
398Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
399the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
400details.
401
402
4032. Configuring HAProxy
404----------------------
405
4062.1. Configuration file format
407------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200408
409HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
410
411 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
412 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
413 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
414 "frontend" and "backend".
415
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100416The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
417referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200418delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100419
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200420
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004212.2. Quoting and escaping
422-------------------------
423
424HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
425many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
426with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
427single quotes.
428
429If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
430them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
431escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
432
433Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
434
435 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
436 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
437 \\ to use a backslash
438 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
439 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
440
441Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
442the interpretation of:
443
444 space as a parameter separator
445 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
446 # hash as a comment start
447
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200448Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
449-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
450backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
451
452Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200453quoting.
454
455Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
456nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
457
458Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
459equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
460
461 Example:
462 # those are equivalents:
463 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
464 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
465 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
466 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
467 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
468
469 # those are equivalents:
470 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
471 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
472 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
473 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
474
475
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004762.3. Environment variables
477--------------------------
478
479HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
480interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
481configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
482optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
483shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
484underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
485
486 Example:
487
488 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
489
490 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
491
492 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
493
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200494Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
495file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200496
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200497* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
498 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
499
500* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
501 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
502 directory.
503
504* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
505
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500506* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200507 processes, separated by semicolons.
508
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500509* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200510 CLI, separated by semicolons.
511
512See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200513
5142.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200515----------------
516
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100517Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100518values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
519otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
520numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
521for every keyword. Supported units are :
522
523 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
524 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
525 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
526 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
527 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
528 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
529
530
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005312.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200532-------------
533
534 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
535 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
536 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
537 global
538 daemon
539 maxconn 256
540
541 defaults
542 mode http
543 timeout connect 5000ms
544 timeout client 50000ms
545 timeout server 50000ms
546
547 frontend http-in
548 bind *:80
549 default_backend servers
550
551 backend servers
552 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
553
554
555 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
556 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
557 global
558 daemon
559 maxconn 256
560
561 defaults
562 mode http
563 timeout connect 5000ms
564 timeout client 50000ms
565 timeout server 50000ms
566
567 listen http-in
568 bind *:80
569 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
570
571
572Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
573
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100574 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200575
576
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005773. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200578--------------------
579
580Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
581are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
582of them have command-line equivalents.
583
584The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
585
586 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200587 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200588 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200589 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200591 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200592 - description
593 - deviceatlas-json-file
594 - deviceatlas-log-level
595 - deviceatlas-separator
596 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900597 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200598 - gid
599 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100600 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200601 - h1-case-adjust
602 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100603 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100604 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100605 - issuers-chain-path
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200607 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100608 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200609 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100610 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200611 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200612 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200613 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200614 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200615 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100616 - presetenv
617 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200618 - uid
619 - ulimit-n
620 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200621 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100622 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200623 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200624 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200625 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200626 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200627 - ssl-default-bind-options
628 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200629 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200630 - ssl-default-server-options
631 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100632 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200633 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100634 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100635 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100636 - 51degrees-data-file
637 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200638 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200639 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200640 - wurfl-data-file
641 - wurfl-information-list
642 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200643 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100644 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100645
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200646 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100647 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200648 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200649 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200650 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100651 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100652 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100653 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200654 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200655 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200656 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200657 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200658 - noepoll
659 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000660 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200661 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100662 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300663 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000664 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100665 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200666 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200667 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200668 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000669 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000670 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200671 - tune.buffers.limit
672 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200673 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200674 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100675 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200676 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200677 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200678 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100679 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200680 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200681 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100682 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100683 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100684 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100685 - tune.lua.session-timeout
686 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200687 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100688 - tune.maxaccept
689 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200690 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200691 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200692 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100693 - tune.rcvbuf.client
694 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100695 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200696 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100697 - tune.sndbuf.client
698 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100699 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100700 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200701 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100702 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200703 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200704 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100705 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200706 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100707 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200708 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
709 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
710 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100711 - tune.zlib.memlevel
712 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100713
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200714 * Debugging
715 - debug
716 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200717 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200718
719
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007203.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200721------------------------------------
722
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200723ca-base <dir>
724 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100725 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
726 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
727 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200728
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200729chroot <jail dir>
730 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
731 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
732 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
733 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
734 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100735 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100736
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100737cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
738 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
739 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
740 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
741 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
742 set. These sets have the format
743
744 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
745
746 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100747 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100748 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
749 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100750 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
751 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100752 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100753 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100754 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100755 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100756 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
757 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
758 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
759 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100760
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100761 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
762 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
763 on the machine's word size.
764
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100765 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100766 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
767 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
768 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
769 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
770 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
771 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100772
773 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100774 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
775
776 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
777 # first 4 CPUs
778
779 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
780 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
781 # word size.
782
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100783 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100784 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100785 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
786 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
787 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
788
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100789 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
790 # and so on.
791 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
792 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
793 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
794
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100795 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100796 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
797 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
798 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
799
800 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
801 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
802 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
803
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100804 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
805 # and a thread range.
806 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
807 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
808 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
809
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200810crt-base <dir>
811 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100812 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
813 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200814
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200815daemon
816 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
817 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100818 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
819 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200820
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200821deviceatlas-json-file <path>
822 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100823 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200824
825deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100826 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200827 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
828
829deviceatlas-separator <char>
830 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
831 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
832
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100833deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200834 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
835 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
836 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100837
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900838external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100839 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
840 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100841 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
842 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
843 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
844 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
845 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900846
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200847gid <number>
848 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
849 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
850 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100851 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
852 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200853 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100854
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100855group <group name>
856 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
857 See also "gid" and "user".
858
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100859hard-stop-after <time>
860 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
861
862 Arguments :
863 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
864 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
865 SIGUSR1 signal.
866
867 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
868 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
869 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
870
871 Example:
872 global
873 hard-stop-after 30s
874
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200875h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
876 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
877 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
878 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
879 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500880 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200881 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
882 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
883 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
884 specified in a proxy.
885
886 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
887 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
888 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
889 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
890 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
891 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
892 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
893
894 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
895 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
896 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
897 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
898 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
899
900 Example:
901 global
902 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
903
904 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
905 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
906
907h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
908 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
909 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
910 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
911 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
912 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
913 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
914 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
915 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
916
917 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
918 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
919 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
920
921 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
922 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
923
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100924insecure-fork-wanted
925 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
926 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
927 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
928 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
929 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
930 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
931 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
932 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
933 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
934 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
935 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
936 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
937 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
938 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
939 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
940 disable it.
941
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100942insecure-setuid-wanted
943 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
944 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
945 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
946 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
947 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
948 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
949 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
950 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
951 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
952 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
953 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
954 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
955 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
956 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
957
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100958issuers-chain-path <dir>
959 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
960 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
961 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
962 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
963 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
964 "issuers-chain-path".
965 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
966 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
967 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
968 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
969 will share the chain in memory.
970
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200971log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
972 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100973 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100974 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100975 configured with "log global".
976
977 <address> can be one of:
978
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100979 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100980 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
981 port).
982
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100983 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
984 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
985 port).
986
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100987 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100988 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
989 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100990 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100991
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100992 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
993 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
994 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
995 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
996 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
997 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
998 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
999 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1000 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1001 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1002 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1003 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1004 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1005 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001006 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1007 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001008
1009 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1010 "fd@2", see above.
1011
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001012 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1013 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1014 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1015 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1016 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1017
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001018 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1019 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001020
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001021 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1022 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1023 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1024 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1025 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1026 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1027 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1028 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1029 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1030 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001031 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1032 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001033
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001034 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1035 one of the following :
1036
1037 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1038 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1039
1040 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1041 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1042
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001043 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1044 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1045 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1046 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1047 logger consumes.
1048
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001049 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1050 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1051 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1052 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1053
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001054 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1055 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1056 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1057 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1058 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1059
1060 <sample_size>
1061 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1062 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1063 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1064 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1065 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1066
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001067 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001068
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001069 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1070 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1071 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1072
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001073 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1074 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1075 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1076 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001077
1078 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001079 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1080 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1081 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1082 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1083 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1084 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001085
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001086 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001087
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001088log-send-hostname [<string>]
1089 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1090 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1091 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1092 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1093 the logs.
1094
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001095log-tag <string>
1096 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1097 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1098 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001099 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001100
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001101lua-load <file>
1102 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1103 used multiple times.
1104
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001105lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1106 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1107 variable.
1108 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1109 to "path".
1110
1111 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1112 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1113 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1114 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1115 will be checked earlier.
1116
1117 As an example by specifying the following path:
1118
1119 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1120 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1121
1122 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1123 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1124 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1125 paths if that does not exist either.
1126
1127 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1128 documentation.
1129
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001130master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001131 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1132 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1133 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001134 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001135 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1136 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001137 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1138 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1139 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1140 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1141 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001142
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001143 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001144
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001145mworker-max-reloads <number>
1146 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001147 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001148 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1149 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1150 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1151
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001152nbproc <number>
1153 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1154 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1155 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001156 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1157 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001158 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1159 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001160
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001161nbthread <number>
1162 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001163 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1164 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1165 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1166 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1167 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001168 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1169 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1170 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1171 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1172 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1173 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1174 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001175
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001176pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001177 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001178 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1179 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1180
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001181presetenv <name> <value>
1182 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1183 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1184 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1185 and "unsetenv".
1186
1187resetenv [<name> ...]
1188 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1189 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1190 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1191 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1192 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1193 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1194 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1195 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1196
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001197stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001198 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1199 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1200 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1201 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1202 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1203 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001204 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001205 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1206 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1207 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1208 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001209
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001210server-state-base <directory>
1211 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001212 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1213 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001214
1215server-state-file <file>
1216 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1217 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1218 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1219 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1220 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1221 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1222 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1223 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001224 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1225 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001226
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001227setenv <name> <value>
1228 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1229 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1230 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1231 and "unsetenv".
1232
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001233set-dumpable
1234 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001235 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1236 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1237 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1238 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1239 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1240 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1241 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1242 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1243 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1244 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1245 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1246 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1247 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1248 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1249 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1250 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1251 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001252
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001253ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1254 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1255 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001256 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001257 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001258 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1259 information and recommendations see e.g.
1260 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1261 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1262 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1263 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001264
1265ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1266 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1267 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1268 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1269 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1270 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001271 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1272 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1273 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001274 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001275
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001276ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1277 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1278 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1279 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1280 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1281 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1282
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001283ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1284 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1285 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1286 keyword to see available options.
1287
1288 Example:
1289 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001290 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001291
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001292ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1293 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1294 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001295 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001296 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001297 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1298 information and recommendations see e.g.
1299 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1300 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1301 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1302 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1303 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001304
1305ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1306 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1307 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1308 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1309 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1310 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001311 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1312 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1313 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1314 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001315
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001316ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1317 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1318 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1319 keyword to see available options.
1320
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001321ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1322 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1323 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1324 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001325 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001326 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001327 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1328 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1329 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1330 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001331 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1332 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1333 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1334
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001335ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001336 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
1337 the loading of the SSL certificates.
1338
1339 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1340 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1341 optimize the startup time.
1342
1343 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1344 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1345 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1346
1347 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001348 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001349
1350 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
1351 will try to load a certificate bundle. This is done by looking for
1352 <basename>.rsa, .ecdsa and .dsa. In the case of directories, HAProxy will
1353 try to gather the files with the same basename in a multi-certificate bundle.
1354 The bundles were introduced with OpenSSL 1.0.2 and were the only way back
1355 then to load an ECDSA certificate and a RSA one, with the same SNI. Since
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001356 OpenSSL 1.1.1 it is not recommended anymore, you can specify both the ECDSA
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001357 and the RSA file on the bind line.
1358
1359 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1360
1361 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1362
1363 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1364 not provided in the PEM file.
1365
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001366 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1367 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1368
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001369 The default behavior is "all".
1370
1371 Example:
1372 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1373 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1374 ssl-load-extra-files none
1375
1376 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1377
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001378ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1379 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1380 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1381 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1382
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001383ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
1384 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the enchor for chain validation: as a
1385 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1386 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1387 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1388 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1389 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1390 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
1391 bits does not need it.
1392
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001393stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1394 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1395 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1396 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001397 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001398 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001399
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001400 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1401 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1402 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001403
1404stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1405 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1406 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001407 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001408
1409stats maxconn <connections>
1410 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1411 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1412
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001413uid <number>
1414 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1415 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1416 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1417 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1418
1419ulimit-n <number>
1420 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1421 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1422 option.
1423
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001424unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1425 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1426
1427 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1428 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1429 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1430 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1431 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1432 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1433 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1434 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1435 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1436 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1437
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001438unsetenv [<name> ...]
1439 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1440 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1441 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1442 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1443 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1444 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1445 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1446
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001447user <user name>
1448 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1449 See also "uid" and "group".
1450
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001451node <name>
1452 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1453
1454 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1455 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1456 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1457 traffic.
1458
1459description <text>
1460 Add a text that describes the instance.
1461
1462 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1463 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1464 "<" and ">" characters.
1465
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100146651degrees-data-file <file path>
1467 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001468 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001469
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001470 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001471 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1472
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000147351degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001474 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1475 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1476 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1477
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001478 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001479 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1480
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200148151degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001482 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1483 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1484
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001485 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1486 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1487
148851degrees-cache-size <number>
1489 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1490 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1491 By default, this cache is disabled.
1492
1493 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001494 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1495
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001496wurfl-data-file <file path>
1497 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1498 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1499
1500 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1501 with USE_WURFL=1.
1502
1503wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1504 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1505 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1506 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1507
1508 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1509
1510 Valid WURFL properties are:
1511 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1512
1513 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1514 device.
1515
1516 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1517 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1518
1519 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1520 particular web request.
1521
1522 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1523 used Libwurfl API version.
1524
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001525 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1526 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1527
1528 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1529 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1530
1531 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1532
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001533 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1534 with USE_WURFL=1.
1535
1536wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1537 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1538 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1539
1540 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1541 with USE_WURFL=1.
1542
1543wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1544 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1545 thus before the chroot.
1546
1547 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1548 with USE_WURFL=1.
1549
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001550wurfl-cache-size <size>
1551 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1552 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001553 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001554 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001555
1556 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1557 with USE_WURFL=1.
1558
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001559strict-limits
1560 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1561 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1562 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1563 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1564 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1565 keyword.
1566
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015673.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001568-----------------------
1569
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001570busy-polling
1571 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1572 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1573 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1574 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1575 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1576 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1577 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1578 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1579 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1580 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1581 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1582 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1583 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1584 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1585 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1586 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1587 "poll" pollers.
1588
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001589 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1590 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1591 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1592
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001593max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1594 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1595 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1596 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1597 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1598 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1599 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1600 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1601 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1602
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001603maxconn <number>
1604 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1605 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1606 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001607 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1608 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1609 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1610 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001611 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1612 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1613 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1614 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1615 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1616 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001617
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001618maxconnrate <number>
1619 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1620 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1621 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1622 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1623 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1624 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1625 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1626 fairness.
1627
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001628maxcomprate <number>
1629 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001630 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001631 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1632 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1633 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001634 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001635 default value.
1636
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001637maxcompcpuusage <number>
1638 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1639 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1640 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1641 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1642 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1643 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1644 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1645 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1646
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001647maxpipes <number>
1648 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1649 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1650 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1651 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1652 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1653 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1654
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001655maxsessrate <number>
1656 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1657 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1658 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1659 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1660 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1661 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1662 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1663 fairness.
1664
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001665maxsslconn <number>
1666 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1667 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1668 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1669 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1670 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1671 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1672 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001673 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1674 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1675 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1676 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1677 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1678 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1679 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001680
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001681maxsslrate <number>
1682 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1683 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1684 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1685 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1686 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1687 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1688 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1689 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1690 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1691 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1692
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001693maxzlibmem <number>
1694 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1695 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1696 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001697 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1698 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1699 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1700
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001701noepoll
1702 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1703 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001704 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001705
1706nokqueue
1707 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1708 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1709 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1710
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001711noevports
1712 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1713 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1714 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1715 also "nopoll".
1716
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001717nopoll
1718 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1719 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001720 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001721 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1722 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001723
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001724nosplice
1725 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001726 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001727 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001728 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001729 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1730 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1731 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1732 "option splice-response".
1733
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001734nogetaddrinfo
1735 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1736 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1737
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001738noreuseport
1739 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1740 command line argument "-dR".
1741
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001742profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1743 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1744 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1745 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1746 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001747 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001748 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1749 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1750 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1751 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1752
1753 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1754 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1755 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1756 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1757 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001758 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1759 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1760 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1761 CLI.
1762
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001763spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001764 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1765 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1766 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1767 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1768 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1769 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001770
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001771ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001772 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001773 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001774 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1775 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1776 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1777 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1778 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001779 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1780 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001781 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1782 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1783 openssl configuration file uses:
1784 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1785
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001786ssl-mode-async
1787 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001788 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001789 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1790 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1791 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001792 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001793 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001794
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001795tune.buffers.limit <number>
1796 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1797 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1798 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1799 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1800 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001801 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001802 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1803 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1804 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1805 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1806 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1807 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1808 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1809 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1810 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1811
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001812tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1813 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1814 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1815 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1816 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1817
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001818tune.bufsize <number>
1819 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1820 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1821 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1822 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1823 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1824 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1825 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001826 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1827 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1828 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001829 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001830 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1831 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1832 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001833
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001834tune.chksize <number>
1835 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1836 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1837 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1838 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1839 checks whenever possible.
1840
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001841tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1842 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1843 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1844 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1845 this value. The default value is 1.
1846
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001847tune.fail-alloc
1848 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1849 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1850 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1851 gracefully.
1852
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001853tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1854 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1855 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1856 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1857 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1858 change it.
1859
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001860tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1861 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001862 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1863 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001864 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1865 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1866 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1867 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1868 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1869
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001870tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1871 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1872 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1873 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1874 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1875 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1876 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1877 recommended not to change this value.
1878
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001879tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1880 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1881 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1882 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1883 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1884 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1885 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1886 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1887
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001888tune.http.cookielen <number>
1889 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1890 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1891 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1892 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1893 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1894 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1895 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1896 to change this value.
1897
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001898tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001899 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1900 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001901 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001902 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001903 configuration directives too.
1904 The default value is 1024.
1905
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001906tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1907 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1908 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1909 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1910 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1911 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1912 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001913 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1914 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1915 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001916
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001917tune.idletimer <timeout>
1918 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1919 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1920 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1921 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1922 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1923 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001924 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001925 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001926 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1927
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001928tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1929 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1930 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1931 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1932 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1933 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1934 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1935 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1936 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1937 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1938
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001939tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1940 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001941 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001942 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1943 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001944 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001945 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1946 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1947
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001948tune.lua.maxmem
1949 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1950 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1951 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1952 memory.
1953
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001954tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1955 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001956 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1957 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001958 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001959
1960tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1961 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1962 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1963 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1964 check servers.
1965
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001966tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1967 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1968 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1969 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001970 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001971
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001972tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001973 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1974 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1975 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1976 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1977 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1978 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1979 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1980 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1981 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1982 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001983
1984tune.maxpollevents <number>
1985 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1986 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1987 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1988 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1989 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1990
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001991tune.maxrewrite <number>
1992 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1993 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1994 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1995 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1996 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1997 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1998 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1999 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2000 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2001 bufsize.
2002
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002003tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2004 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2005 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2006 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2007 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2008 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2009 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2010 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2011 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2012 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002013 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2014 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002015 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2016 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2017 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2018 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2019 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2020 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2021 setting this parameter to 0.
2022
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002023tune.pipesize <number>
2024 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2025 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2026 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2027 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2028 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2029 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2030
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002031tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2032 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2033 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2034 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2035 default is 20.
2036
2037tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2038 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2039 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2040 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2041 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2042 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2043 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002044 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002045
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002046tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2047tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2048 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2049 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2050 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002051 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002052 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002053 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2054 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2055
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002056tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002057 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002058 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2059 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2060 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2061 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2062
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002063tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002064 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002065 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
2066 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
2067
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002068tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2069tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2070 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2071 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2072 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002073 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002074 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002075 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2076 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2077 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2078 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2079 notifying haproxy again.
2080
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002081tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002082 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2083 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2084 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002085 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002086 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002087 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002088 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2089 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2090 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002091 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2092 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002093
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002094tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002095 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002096 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2097 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2098 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2099 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2100 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2101
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002102tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2103 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002104 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002105 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2106 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2107 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2108 being used for too long.
2109
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002110tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2111 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2112 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2113 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2114 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2115 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2116 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2117 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2118 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2119 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2120 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002121 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002122 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002123
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002124tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2125 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2126 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2127 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2128 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2129 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
2130 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2131 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002132 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2133 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002134
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002135tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2136 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2137 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2138 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2139 1000 entries.
2140
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002141tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2142 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2143 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2144 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2145
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002146tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002147tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002148tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2149tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2150tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002151 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2152 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2153 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2154 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2155 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2156 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2157 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2158 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002159
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002160 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2161 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2162 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2163 all available space is consumed.
2164 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2165 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2166 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002167
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002168tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2169 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002170 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002171 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002172 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002173 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2174
2175tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2176 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2177 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002178 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2179 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002180
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021813.3. Debugging
2182--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002183
Willy Tarreau1b857852020-02-25 11:27:22 +01002184debug (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002185 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2186 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2187 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2188 system startup.
2189
2190quiet
2191 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2192 line argument "-q".
2193
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002194zero-warning
2195 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2196 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2197 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2198 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2199 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2200 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2201
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002202
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022033.4. Userlists
2204--------------
2205It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2206http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2207it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2208
2209userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002210 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002211 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2212
2213group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002214 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002215 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2216 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2217
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002218user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2219 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002220 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2221 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002222 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2223 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2224 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2225 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002226
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002227 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2228 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2229 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2230 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2231 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2232 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2233 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2234 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2235 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002236
2237 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002238 userlist L1
2239 group G1 users tiger,scott
2240 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002241
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002242 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2243 user scott insecure-password elgato
2244 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002245
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002246 userlist L2
2247 group G1
2248 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002249
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002250 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2251 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2252 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002253
2254 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002255
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002256
22573.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002258----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002259It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2260several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2261instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2262values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2263automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2264In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2265using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2266tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2267reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2268Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2269that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2270each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002271
2272peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002273 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002274 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2275
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002276bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2277 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2278 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2279
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002280disabled
2281 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2282 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2283 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2284
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002285default-bind [param*]
2286 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2287
2288default-server [param*]
2289 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2290
2291 Arguments:
2292 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2293 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2294 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2295 details.
2296
2297
2298 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2299
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002300enable
2301 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2302
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002303log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2304 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2305 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2306 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2307 more details.
2308
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002309peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002310 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2311 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2312 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2313 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2314 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2315 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2316
2317 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2318 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2319
2320 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2321 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2322 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2323 across all peers.
2324
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002325 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2326 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002327
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002328 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2329 "server" keyword explanation below).
2330
2331server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002332 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002333 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2334 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2335 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2336 of this "peers" section).
2337 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2338
2339
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002340 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002341 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002342 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002343 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2344 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2345 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002346
2347 backend mybackend
2348 mode tcp
2349 balance roundrobin
2350 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2351 stick on src
2352
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002353 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2354 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002355
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002356 Example:
2357 peers mypeers
2358 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2359 default-server ssl verify none
2360 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2361 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002362
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002363
2364table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2365 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2366
2367 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2368 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002369 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002370 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2371 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2372 "stick-table" keyword).
2373
2374 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2375 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2376 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2377 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2378 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2379 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2380 of the stick-table name as follows:
2381
2382 peers mypeers
2383 peer A ...
2384 peer B ...
2385 table t1 ...
2386
2387 frontend fe1
2388 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2389
2390 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2391 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2392
2393 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2394 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2395 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2396 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2397 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2398 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2399 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2400
2401 peers mypeers
2402 peer A ...
2403 peer B ...
2404 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2405
2406 backend t1
2407 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2408
2409 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2410 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2411 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2412
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090024133.6. Mailers
2414------------
2415It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2416If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2417in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2418
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002419mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002420 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2421 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2422
2423mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2424 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2425
2426 Example:
2427 mailers mymailers
2428 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2429 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2430
2431 backend mybackend
2432 mode tcp
2433 balance roundrobin
2434
2435 email-alert mailers mymailers
2436 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2437 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2438
2439 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2440 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2441
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002442timeout mail <time>
2443 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2444 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2445 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2446 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2447
2448 Example:
2449 mailers mymailers
2450 timeout mail 20s
2451 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002452
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020024533.7. Programs
2454-------------
2455In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2456master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2457managed the same way as the workers.
2458
2459During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2460sequence as a worker:
2461
2462 - the master is re-executed
2463 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2464 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2465 instance of the program
2466
2467During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2468
2469program <name>
2470 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2471 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2472 the management guide).
2473
2474command <command> [arguments*]
2475 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2476 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2477 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2478 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2479
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002480user <user name>
2481 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2482 See also "group".
2483
2484group <group name>
2485 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2486 See also "user".
2487
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002488option start-on-reload
2489no option start-on-reload
2490 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2491 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2492 program section.
2493
2494
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010024953.8. HTTP-errors
2496----------------
2497
2498It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2499imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2500several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2501
2502http-errors <name>
2503 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2504 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2505
2506errorfile <code> <file>
2507 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2508
2509 Arguments :
2510 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2511 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429,
2512 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2513
2514 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2515 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2516 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2517 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2518 before any chroot is performed.
2519
2520 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2521
2522 Example:
2523 http-errors website-1
2524 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2525 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2526 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2527
2528 http-errors website-2
2529 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2530 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2531 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2532
2533
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025344. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002535----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002536
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002537Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002538 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002539 - frontend <name>
2540 - backend <name>
2541 - listen <name>
2542
2543A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2544its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2545section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002546section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002547
2548A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2549connections.
2550
2551A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2552to forward incoming connections.
2553
2554A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2555parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2556
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002557All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2558'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2559case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2560
2561Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2562logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2563proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2564However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2565name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2566
2567Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2568and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002569bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002570protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2571modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2572arbitrary criteria.
2573
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002574In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2575a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002576the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002577
2578 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2579 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2580 between responses and new requests.
2581
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002582 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2583 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2584 client-facing connection remains open.
2585
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002586 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2587 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002588
2589The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2590frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2591following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002592weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002593
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002594 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002595
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002596 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2597 ----+-----+-----+----
2598 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2599 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002600 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2601 ----+-----+-----+----
2602 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002603
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002604
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002605
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026064.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2607--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002608
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002609The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2610limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2611they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2612limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002613marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002614option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002615and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2616with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2617specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002618
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002619
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002620 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2621------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2622acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002623backlog X X X -
2624balance X - X X
2625bind - X X -
2626bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002627capture cookie - X X -
2628capture request header - X X -
2629capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002630compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002631cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002632declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002633default-server X - X X
2634default_backend X X X -
2635description - X X X
2636disabled X X X X
2637dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002638email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002639email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002640email-alert mailers X X X X
2641email-alert myhostname X X X X
2642email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002643enabled X X X X
2644errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002645errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002646errorloc X X X X
2647errorloc302 X X X X
2648-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2649errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002650force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002651filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002652fullconn X - X X
2653grace X X X X
2654hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002655http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002656http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002657http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002658http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002659http-check expect X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002660http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002661http-check set-var X - X X
2662http-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002663http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002664http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002665http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002666http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002667id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002668ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002669load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002670log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002671log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002672log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002673log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002674max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002675maxconn X X X -
2676mode X X X X
2677monitor fail - X X -
2678monitor-net X X X -
2679monitor-uri X X X -
2680option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2681option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2682option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2683option allbackups (*) X - X X
2684option checkcache (*) X - X X
2685option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2686option contstats (*) X X X -
2687option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2688option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002689-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2690option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002691option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2692option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002693option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002694option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002695option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002696option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002697option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002698option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2699option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2700option httpchk X - X X
2701option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002702option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002703option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002704option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002705option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002706option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002707option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2708option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2709option logasap (*) X X X -
2710option mysql-check X - X X
2711option nolinger (*) X X X X
2712option originalto X X X X
2713option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002714option pgsql-check X - X X
2715option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002716option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002717option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002718option smtpchk X - X X
2719option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2720option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2721option splice-request (*) X X X X
2722option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002723option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002724option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2725option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2726-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002727option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002728option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2729option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2730option tcpka X X X X
2731option tcplog X X X X
2732option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002733external-check command X - X X
2734external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002735persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2736rate-limit sessions X X X -
2737redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002738-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002739retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002740retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002741server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002742server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002743server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002744source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002745stats admin - X X X
2746stats auth X X X X
2747stats enable X X X X
2748stats hide-version X X X X
2749stats http-request - X X X
2750stats realm X X X X
2751stats refresh X X X X
2752stats scope X X X X
2753stats show-desc X X X X
2754stats show-legends X X X X
2755stats show-node X X X X
2756stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002757-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2758stick match - - X X
2759stick on - - X X
2760stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002761stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002762stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002763tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002764tcp-check connect X - X X
2765tcp-check expect X - X X
2766tcp-check send X - X X
2767tcp-check send-binary X - X X
2768tcp-check set-var X - X X
2769tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002770tcp-request connection - X X -
2771tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002772tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002773tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002774tcp-response content - - X X
2775tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002776timeout check X - X X
2777timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002778timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002779timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002780timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2781timeout http-request X X X X
2782timeout queue X - X X
2783timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002784timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002785timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002786timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002787transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002788unique-id-format X X X -
2789unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002790use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002791use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002792use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002793------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2794 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002795
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002796
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027974.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2798---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002799
2800This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2801
2802
2803acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2804 Declare or complete an access list.
2805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2806 no | yes | yes | yes
2807 Example:
2808 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2809 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2810 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2811
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002812 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002813
2814
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002815backlog <conns>
2816 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2818 yes | yes | yes | no
2819 Arguments :
2820 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2821 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002822 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002823
2824 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2825 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2826 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2827 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2828 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2829 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2830 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2831 backlog parameter.
2832
2833 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2834 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2835 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2836
2837 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2838
2839
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002840balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002841balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002842 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2844 yes | no | yes | yes
2845 Arguments :
2846 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2847 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2848 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2849 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2850
2851 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2852 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2853 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2854 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002855 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002856 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002857 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2858 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2859 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2860 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2861 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2862 it, so that you don't worry.
2863
2864 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2865 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2866 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2867 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2868 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2869 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2870 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2871 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002872
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002873 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2874 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2875 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2876 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2877 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2878 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2879 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2880 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2881
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002882 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002883 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002884 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2885 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002886 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002887 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2888 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2889 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2890 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2891 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002892 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2893 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2894 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2895 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2896 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2897 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002898
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002899 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2900 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2901 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2902 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2903 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2904 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2905 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2906 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002907 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002908 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002909 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2910 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2911 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002912
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002913 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2914 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2915 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2916 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2917 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2918 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2919 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2920 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2921 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2922 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2923 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2924 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002925
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002926 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002927 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2928 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2929 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2930 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2931 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2932 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2933 URIs start with a leading "/".
2934
2935 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2936 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2937 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2938 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2939
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002940 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002941 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2942
2943 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002944 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2945 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002946 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2947 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2948 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2949 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002950 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002951 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2952 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002953
2954 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2955 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2956 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2957 server will receive the request.
2958
2959 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2960 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2961 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2962 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2963 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002964 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2965 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2966 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002967
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002968 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2969 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2970 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2971 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2972 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002973
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002974 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002975 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2976 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2977 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2978
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002979 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2980 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2981 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2982
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002983 random
2984 random(<draws>)
2985 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002986 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2987 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2988 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2989 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002990 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2991 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2992 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2993 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2994 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2995 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2996 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2997 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2998 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2999 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3000 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3001 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3002 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3003 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3004 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3005 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3006 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3007 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3008 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3009 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003010
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003011 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003012 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003013 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3014 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3015 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3016 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3017 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3018 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003019 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003020 used instead.
3021
3022 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3023 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3024 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3025 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3026
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003027 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3028 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3029 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3030
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003031 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003032
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003033 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003034 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3035 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003036
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003037 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3038 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3039 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003040
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003041 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003042 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003043 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3044 NTLM relies on.
3045
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003046 Examples :
3047 balance roundrobin
3048 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003049 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003050 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3051 balance hdr(host)
3052 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003053
3054 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3055 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3056
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003057 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003058 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3059 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3060 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003061 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003062
3063 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3064 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3065 defaults to 16 kB.
3066
3067 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3068 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3069
3070 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3071 Round Robin.
3072
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003073 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003074 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3075 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3076 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3077
3078 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3079
3080 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003081 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003082 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3083 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3084 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003085
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003086 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003087
3088
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003089bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3090bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003091 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3093 no | yes | yes | no
3094 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003095 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3096 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3097 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3098 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003099 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003100 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3101 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3102 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3103 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3104 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3105 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
3106 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003107 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3108 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3109 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3110 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3111 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3112 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3113 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003114 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3115 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3116 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003117 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3118 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3119 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3120 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003121 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3122 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3123 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003124
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003125 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3126 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003127 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3128 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3129 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003130 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3131 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3132 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3133 the range.
3134
3135 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3136 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3137 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3138 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3139 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3140 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3141 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003142 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003143 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003144
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003145 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003146 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003147 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3148 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3149 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3150 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3151 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3152 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3153
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003154 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3155 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3156 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3157 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003158
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003159 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3160 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3161 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3162 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3163 in a frontend.
3164
3165 Example :
3166 listen http_proxy
3167 bind :80,:443
3168 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003169 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003170
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003171 listen http_https_proxy
3172 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003173 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003174
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003175 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3176 bind ipv6@:80
3177 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3178 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3179
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003180 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003181 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003182
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003183 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3184 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3185 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3186 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3187 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3188
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003189 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003190 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003191
3192
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003193bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003194 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3196 yes | yes | yes | yes
3197 Arguments :
3198 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3199 may be used to override a default value.
3200
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003201 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003202 option may be combined with other numbers.
3203
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003204 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003205 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3206 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3207 missing from all processes.
3208
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003209 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003210 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003211 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3212 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3213 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3214 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3215 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003216 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003217
3218 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3219 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3220 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3221 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3222 and 'even' instances.
3223
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003224 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3225 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3226 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3227 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003228
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003229 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3230 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3231
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003232 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3233 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3234 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3235
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003236 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3237 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3238
3239 Example :
3240 listen app_ip1
3241 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003242 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003243
3244 listen app_ip2
3245 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003246 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003247
3248 listen management
3249 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003250 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003251
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003252 listen management
3253 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3254 bind-process 1-4
3255
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003256 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003257
3258
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003259capture cookie <name> len <length>
3260 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3262 no | yes | yes | no
3263 Arguments :
3264 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3265 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3266 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3267 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003268 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003269
3270 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3271 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3272 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3273 right if it exceeds <length>.
3274
3275 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3276 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3277 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3278 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3279
3280 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3281 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3282 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3283
3284 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3285 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3286 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003287 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3288 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3289 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003290
3291 Example:
3292 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3293
3294 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003295 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003296
3297
3298capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003299 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3301 no | yes | yes | no
3302 Arguments :
3303 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003304 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003305 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3306 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3307 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3308
3309 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3310 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3311 it exceeds <length>.
3312
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003313 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003314 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3315 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003316 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3317 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3318 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3319 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003320 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003321 environments to find where the request came from.
3322
3323 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3324 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3325 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3326 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003327
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003328 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3329 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3330 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3331 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3332 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003333
3334 Example:
3335 capture request header Host len 15
3336 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003337 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003338
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003339 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003340 about logging.
3341
3342
3343capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003344 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3346 no | yes | yes | no
3347 Arguments :
3348 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003349 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003350 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3351 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3352 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3353
3354 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3355 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3356 it exceeds <length>.
3357
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003358 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003359 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3360 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3361 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003362 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3363 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3364 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3365 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003366
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003367 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3368 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3369 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3370 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3371 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003372
3373 Example:
3374 capture response header Content-length len 9
3375 capture response header Location len 15
3376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003377 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003378 about logging.
3379
3380
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003381compression algo <algorithm> ...
3382compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003383compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003384 Enable HTTP compression.
3385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3386 yes | yes | yes | yes
3387 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003388 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3389 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3390 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3391
3392 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003393 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3394 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3395 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003396
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003397 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003398 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003399
3400 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3401 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3402 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3403 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3404 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003405 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003406
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003407 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3408 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3409 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3410 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3411 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3412 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3413 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003414 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003415
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003416 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003417 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003418 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3419 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3420 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3421 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3422 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003423
3424 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3425 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3426 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3427 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3428 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003429 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3430 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3431 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3432 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3433 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003434 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3435 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003436
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003437 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003438 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3439 "Accept-Encoding" header
3440 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003441 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003442 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3443 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3444 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3445 "multipart"
3446 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3447 header
3448 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3449 and later
3450 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3451 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003452 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003453
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003454 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003455
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003456 Examples :
3457 compression algo gzip
3458 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003459
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003460
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003461cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003462 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3463 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003464 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003465 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3467 yes | no | yes | yes
3468 Arguments :
3469 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3470 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3471 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3472 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3473 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3474 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003475 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003476 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3477 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3478
3479 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3480 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3481 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3482 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3483 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3484 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003485 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3486 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003487 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003488 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3489 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003490
3491 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003492 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003493
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003494 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003495 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003496 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003497 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003498 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3499 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3500 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3501 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3502 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3503 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3504 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003505
3506 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3507 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3508 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3509 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3510 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3511 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3512 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3513 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3514 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003515 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003516 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3517 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3518 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003519
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003520 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3521 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3522 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003523 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3524 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3525 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3526 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003527 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3528 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3529 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003530
3531 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3532 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3533 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3534 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3535 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3536 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3537 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3538 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3539 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3540
3541 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3542 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3543 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3544 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3545 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3546 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3547 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3548 persistence cookie in the cache.
3549 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3550
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003551 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3552 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3553 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3554 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3555 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003556 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003557 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3558 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3559 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3560 they logout.
3561
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003562 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3563 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3564 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3565 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3566
3567 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3568 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3569 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3570 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3571 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3572 this attribute.
3573
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003574 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003575 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003576 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3577 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3578 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3579 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3580 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3581 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003582
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003583 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3584 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3585 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3586 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3587 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3588 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3589 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3590 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003591 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003592 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3593 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3594 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3595 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3596 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3597 the site.
3598
3599 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3600 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3601 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3602 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3603 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3604 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3605 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3606 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3607 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3608 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3609 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3610 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3611 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003612 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003613 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3614 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3615
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003616 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3617 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3618 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3619 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3620 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3621 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3622
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003623 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3624 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3625 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3626 repeated.
3627
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003628 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3629 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3630 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3631 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003632
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003633 Examples :
3634 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3635 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3636 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003637 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003638
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003639 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003640
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003641
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003642declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3643 Declares a capture slot.
3644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3645 no | yes | yes | no
3646 Arguments:
3647 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3648
3649 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3650 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3651 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3652 for use in the response.
3653
3654 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003655 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003656 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3657
3658
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003659default-server [param*]
3660 Change default options for a server in a backend
3661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3662 yes | no | yes | yes
3663 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003664 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3665 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3666 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3667 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003668
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003669 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003670 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3671
3672 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003673
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003674
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003675default_backend <backend>
3676 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3678 yes | yes | yes | no
3679 Arguments :
3680 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3681
3682 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3683 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3684 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3685 will catch all undetermined requests.
3686
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003687 Example :
3688
3689 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3690 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3691 default_backend dynamic
3692
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003693 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003694
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003695
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003696description <string>
3697 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3699 no | yes | yes | yes
3700 Arguments : string
3701
3702 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3703 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3704 it describes.
3705 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3706
3707
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003708disabled
3709 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3711 yes | yes | yes | yes
3712 Arguments : none
3713
3714 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3715 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3716 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3717 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3718 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3719 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3720 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3721
3722 See also : "enabled"
3723
3724
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003725dispatch <address>:<port>
3726 Set a default server address
3727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3728 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003729 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003730
3731 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3732 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3733 during start-up.
3734
3735 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3736 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3737 possible with normal servers.
3738
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003739 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003740 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3741 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3742 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3743 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3744
3745 See also : "server"
3746
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003747
3748dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3749 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3751 yes | no | yes | yes
3752 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3753
3754 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003755 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003756 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3757 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003758 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003759 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003760
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003761enabled
3762 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3764 yes | yes | yes | yes
3765 Arguments : none
3766
3767 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3768 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3769
3770 See also : "disabled"
3771
3772
3773errorfile <code> <file>
3774 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3776 yes | yes | yes | yes
3777 Arguments :
3778 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003779 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3780 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003781
3782 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003783 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003784 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003785 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3786 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003787
3788 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3789 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3790 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3791
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003792 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3793
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003794 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3795 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3796 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3797 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3798
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003799 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3800 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003801 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003802 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3803 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3804 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3805
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003806 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3807 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3808 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003809 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003810 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3811
3812 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3813
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003814 Example :
3815 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003816 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003817 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3818 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3819
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003820
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003821errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
3822 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
3823 section.
3824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3825 yes | yes | yes | yes
3826 Arguments :
3827 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
3828
3829 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
3830 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 403,
3831 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3832
3833 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
3834 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
3835 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
3836 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
3837 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
3838 ones. Fonctionnly, it is exactly the same than declaring all error files by
3839 hand using "errorfile" directives.
3840
3841 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" , "errorloc303" and section
3842 3.8 about http-errors.
3843
3844 Example :
3845 errorfiles generic
3846 errorfiles site-1 403 404
3847
3848
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003849errorloc <code> <url>
3850errorloc302 <code> <url>
3851 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3853 yes | yes | yes | yes
3854 Arguments :
3855 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003856 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3857 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003858
3859 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3860 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3861 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3862 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003863 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003864
3865 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3866 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3867 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3868
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003869 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3870
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003871 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3872 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3873 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3874 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003875 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003876 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3877 request.
3878
3879 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3880
3881
3882errorloc303 <code> <url>
3883 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3885 yes | yes | yes | yes
3886 Arguments :
3887 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003888 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3889 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003890
3891 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3892 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3893 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3894 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003895 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003896
3897 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3898 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3899 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3900
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003901 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3902
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003903 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3904 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3905 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3906 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003907 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003908
3909 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3910
3911
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003912email-alert from <emailaddr>
3913 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003914 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003915 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3916 yes | yes | yes | yes
3917
3918 Arguments :
3919
3920 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3921
3922 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3923 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3924
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003925 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003926 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3927 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003928
3929
3930email-alert level <level>
3931 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3932 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3933 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3934 yes | yes | yes | yes
3935
3936 Arguments :
3937
3938 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3939 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3940 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3941
3942 By default level is alert
3943
3944 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3945 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3946 for the proxy.
3947
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003948 Alerts are sent when :
3949
3950 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3951 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3952 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3953 is notice or lower
3954 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3955 and a health check status update occurs
3956
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003957 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3958 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003959 section 3.6 about mailers.
3960
3961
3962email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3963 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3964 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3965 yes | yes | yes | yes
3966
3967 Arguments :
3968
3969 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3970
3971 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3972 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3973
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003974 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3975 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003976
3977
3978email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3979 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3980 mailers.
3981 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3982 yes | yes | yes | yes
3983
3984 Arguments :
3985
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003986 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003987
3988 By default the systems hostname is used.
3989
3990 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3991 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3992 for the proxy.
3993
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003994 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3995 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003996
3997
3998email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003999 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004000 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4001 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4002 yes | yes | yes | yes
4003
4004 Arguments :
4005
4006 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4007
4008 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4009 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4010
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004011 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004012 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4013
4014
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004015force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4016 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4017 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004018 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004019
4020 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4021 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4022 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4023 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4024 marked down for maintenance operations.
4025
4026 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4027 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4028 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4029 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4030 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4031 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4032 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4033 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4034 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4035
4036 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4037 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4038 is used.
4039
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004040 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004041 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004042
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004043
4044filter <name> [param*]
4045 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4047 no | yes | yes | yes
4048 Arguments :
4049 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4050 referenced in section 9.
4051
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004052 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004053 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004054 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4055 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004056
4057 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4058 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4059
4060 Example:
4061 listen
4062 bind *:80
4063
4064 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4065 filter compression
4066 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4067
4068 compression algo gzip
4069 compression offload
4070
4071 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4072
4073 See also : section 9.
4074
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004075
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004076fullconn <conns>
4077 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4079 yes | no | yes | yes
4080 Arguments :
4081 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4082 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4083
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004084 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004085 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004086 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004087 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4088 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4089 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4090 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4091 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004092 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004093
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004094 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4095 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004096 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4097 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4098 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004099
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004100 Example :
4101 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4102 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4103 # connections.
4104 backend dynamic
4105 fullconn 10000
4106 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4107 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4108
4109 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4110
4111
4112grace <time>
4113 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004115 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004116 Arguments :
4117 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4118 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4119 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4120
4121 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4122 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004123 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004124 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4125
4126 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4127 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4128 simplify it.
4129
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004130
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004131hash-balance-factor <factor>
4132 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4134 yes | no | no | yes
4135 Arguments :
4136 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4137 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004138 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004139
4140 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4141 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4142 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4143 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4144 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4145 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4146 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4147
4148 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4149 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4150 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4151 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4152 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4153
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004154 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4155 consistent hashing mechanism.
4156
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004157 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4158
4159
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004160hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004161 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4163 yes | no | yes | yes
4164 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004165 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4166 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004167
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004168 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4169 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4170 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4171 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4172 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4173 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4174 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4175 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4176 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4177 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004178
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004179 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4180 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4181 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4182 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4183 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4184 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4185 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4186 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4187 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4188 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4189 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4190 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4191 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004192 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4193 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004194
4195 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4196
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004197 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004198 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4199 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4200 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004201 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4202 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4203 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004204
4205 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4206 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004207 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4208 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4209 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4210 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4211
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004212 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4213 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4214 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4215 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4216 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4217 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4218 parameter.
4219
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004220 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4221 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4222 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4223 used on strings.
4224
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004225 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4226
4227 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4228 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4229 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4230 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4231 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4232 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4233 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4234 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4235 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4236 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4237 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4238 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004239
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004240 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4241 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4242 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004243
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004244 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004245
4246
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004247http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4248 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4249 ones).
4250
4251 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4252 no | yes | yes | yes
4253
4254 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4255 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4256 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4257 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4258 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4259 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4260
4261 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4262 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4263 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4264
4265 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4266 below.
4267
4268 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4269 instance.
4270
4271 Example:
4272 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4273 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4274 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4275
4276http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4277
4278 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4279 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4280 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4281 example, or to pass some internal information.
4282 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4283 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4284 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4285
4286http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4287
4288 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4289 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4290
4291http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4292
4293 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4294
4295http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4296 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4297
4298 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4299
4300 Example:
4301 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4302
4303 # applied to:
4304 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4305
4306 # outputs:
4307 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4308
4309 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4310
4311http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4312 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4313
4314 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4315
4316 Example:
4317 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4318
4319 # applied to:
4320 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4321
4322 # outputs:
4323 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4324
4325http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4326
4327 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4328 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4329 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4330
4331http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4332 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4333
4334 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4335 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4336 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4337 fallback.
4338
4339 Example:
4340 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4341 http-response set-status 431
4342 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4343 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4344
4345http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4346
4347 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4348 inline.
4349
4350 Arguments:
4351 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4352 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4353 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4354 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4355 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4356 (request and response)
4357 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4358 processing
4359 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4360 processing
4361 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4362 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4363 and '_'.
4364
4365 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4366 followed by some converters.
4367
4368 Example:
4369 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4370
4371http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4372
4373 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4374 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4375 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4376 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4377 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004378 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004379 processing.
4380
4381 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4382 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
4383 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
4384 rules evaluation.
4385
4386http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4387
4388 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4389 details about <var-name>.
4390
4391 Example:
4392 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4393
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004394
4395http-check comment <string>
4396 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
4397 it fails.
4398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4399 yes | no | yes | yes
4400
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004401 Arguments :
4402 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
4403 rule fails.
4404
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004405 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
4406 user-friendly error reporting.
4407
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004408 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check conncet", "http-check send" and
4409 "http-check expect".
4410
4411
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004412http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
4413 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004414 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004415 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
4416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4417 yes | no | yes | yes
4418
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004419 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004420 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4421
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004422 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
4423 checks. The server options are used only if not redifined.
4424
4425 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
4426 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
4427 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
4428 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
4429
4430 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
4431
4432 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
4433
4434 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
4435
4436 ssl opens a ciphered connection
4437
4438 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
4439
4440 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
4441 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
4442 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
4443 is used.
4444
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004445 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
4446 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
4447 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
4448 haproxy -vv.
4449
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004450 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
4451
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004452 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
4453 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
4454 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
4455 different ports or with different servers.
4456
4457 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
4458 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
4459 the port with a "http-check connect".
4460
4461 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
4462 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
4463 do.
4464
4465 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
4466 unset-var or comment rules.
4467
4468 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004469 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
4470 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
4471 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
4472 option httpchk
4473
4474 http-check connect
4475 http-check send GET / HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004476 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004477 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
4478 http-check send GET / HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004479 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004480
4481 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
4482
4483 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004484
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004485
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004486http-check disable-on-404
4487 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004489 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004490 Arguments : none
4491
4492 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4493 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4494 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4495 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4496 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4497 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4498 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4499 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004500 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4501 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4502 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4503
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004504 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004505
4506
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004507http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004508 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
4509 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
4510 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004511 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004513 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004514
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004515 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004516 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4517
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004518 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
4519 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
4520 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
4521 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
4522 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
4523 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
4524 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
4525 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
4526 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
4527 result is always conclusive.
4528
4529 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4530 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
4531 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
4532 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported and may be used to set,
4533 respectively, HCHK_STATUS_L7OK, HCHK_STATUS_L7OKCD,
4534 HCHK_STATUS_L6OK or HCHK_STATUS_L4OK success status.
4535 By default "L7OK" is used.
4536
4537 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4538 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
4539 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported and
4540 may be used to set, respectively, HCHK_STATUS_L7RSP,
4541 HCHK_STATUS_L7STS, HCHK_STATUS_L6RSP or HCHK_STATUS_L4CON
4542 error status. By default "L7RSP" is used.
4543
4544 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4545 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
4546 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported and may
4547 be used to set, respectively, HCHK_STATUS_L7TOUT,
4548 HCHK_STATUS_L6TOUT or HCHK_STATUS_L4TOUT timeout status.
4549 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
4550
4551 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4552 informational message reported in logs if the expect
4553 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
4554 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
4555
4556 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4557 informational message reported in logs if an error
4558 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
4559 log-format string.
4560
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004561 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4562 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004563 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004564 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4565 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4566 details on the supported keywords.
4567
4568 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4569 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4570 with the usual backslash ('\').
4571
4572 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4573 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4574 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4575 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4576 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4577
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004578 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
4579 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
4580 codes. A health check response will be considered as
4581 valid if the response's status code matches any status
4582 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
4583 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4584 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004585
4586 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004587 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004588 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4589 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4590 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4591 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4592
4593 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004594 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004595 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4596 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4597 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4598 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4599 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004600 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004601 trace).
4602
4603 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004604 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004605 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4606 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4607 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4608 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4609 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004610 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004611
4612 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4613 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4614 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4615 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4616 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4617 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4618 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4619 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4620
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004621 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
4622 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
4623 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
4624 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
4625 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004626
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004627 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4628 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4629
4630 Examples :
4631 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004632 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004633
4634 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004635 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004636
4637 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004638 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004639
4640 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004641 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004642
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004643 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004644 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004645
4646
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02004647http-check send [meth <method>] [uri <uri>] [ver <version>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004648 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [body <string>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004649 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
4650 health checks.
4651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4652 yes | no | yes | yes
4653 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004654 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4655
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004656 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
4657 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
4658 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
4659 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
4660 to invent non-standard ones.
4661
4662 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests.
4663 it defaults to " / " which is accessible by default on almost
4664 any server, but may be changed to any other URI. Query
4665 strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004666
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02004667 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004668 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
4669 1.0, so turningit to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
4670 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
4671 to add it.
4672
4673 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4674 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
4675 to the log-format rules.
4676
4677 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
4678 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
4679 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004680
4681 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
4682 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
4683 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
4684 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. The old trick consisting to
4685 add headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
4686 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
4687 "http-check expect" direcive is defined independently of this directive, just
4688 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
4689
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004690 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4691 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4692 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send".
4693
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004694 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004695
4696
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004697http-check send-state
4698 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4700 yes | no | yes | yes
4701 Arguments : none
4702
4703 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4704 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4705 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4706 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4707 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4708
4709 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4710 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4711 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4712 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4713 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004714 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4715 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4716 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4717
4718 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4719 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4720 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4721
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004722 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4723 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4724 checked in multiple backends.
4725
4726 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4727 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4728
4729 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4730 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4731 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4732 one fails.
4733
4734 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4735 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4736 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4737
4738 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4739 server's queue.
4740
4741 Example of a header received by the application server :
4742 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4743 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4744
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004745 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
4746 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004747
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004748
4749http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004750 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004751 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4752 yes | no | yes | yes
4753
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004754 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004755 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4756 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
4757 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
4758 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
4759 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
4760 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4761 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
4762 and '-'.
4763
4764 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
4765
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004766 Examples :
4767 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004768
4769
4770http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004771 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004772 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4773 yes | no | yes | yes
4774
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004775 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004776 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4777 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
4778 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
4779 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
4780 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
4781 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4782 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
4783 and '-'.
4784
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004785 Examples :
4786 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004787
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004788
4789http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004790 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4791
4792 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4793 no | yes | yes | yes
4794
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004795 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4796 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4797 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4798 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4799 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004800
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004801 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4802 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004803
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004804 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004805
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004806 Example:
4807 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4808 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4809 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004810
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004811 http-request allow if nagios
4812 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4813 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4814 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004815
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004816 Example:
4817 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4818 acl add path /addacl
4819 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004820
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004821 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004822
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004823 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4824 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004825
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004826 Example:
4827 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4828 acl setmap path /setmap
4829 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004830
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004831 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004832
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004833 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4834 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004835
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004836 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4837 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004838
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004839http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004840
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004841 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4842 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4843 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4844 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4845 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4846 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4847 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4848 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004849
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004850http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004851
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004852 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4853 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4854 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4855 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4856 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4857 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4858 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4859 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004860
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004861http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004862
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004863 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4864 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004865
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004866
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004867http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004868
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004869 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4870 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4871 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4872 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4873 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004874
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004875 Example:
4876 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4877 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004878
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004879http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004880
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004881 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004882
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004883http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4884 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004885
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004886 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4887 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4888 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4889 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4890 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4891 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4892 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4893 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4894 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004895
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004896 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4897 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4898 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01004899 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
4900
4901 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
4902 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
4903 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
4904 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004905
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004906http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004907
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004908 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4909 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4910 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4911 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4912 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4913 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004914
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004915http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004916
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004917 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004918
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004919http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004920
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004921 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4922 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4923 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4924 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4925 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4926 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004927
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004928http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
4929 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004930
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004931 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4932 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4933 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004934 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
4935 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
4936 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
4937 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
4938 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004939 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004940
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004941http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4942 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4943 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4944 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4945
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004946http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4947
4948 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4949 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4950 pointed by <resolvers>.
4951 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4952 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4953 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4954 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4955 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4956 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4957 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4958 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4959 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4960 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4961 to 0.0.0.0.
4962
4963 Example:
4964 resolvers mydns
4965 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4966 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4967 timeout retry 1s
4968 hold valid 10s
4969 hold nx 3s
4970 hold other 3s
4971 hold obsolete 0s
4972 accepted_payload_size 8192
4973
4974 frontend fe
4975 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4976 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4977 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4978
4979 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4980 # which mean DNS resolution error
4981 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4982
4983 default_backend be
4984
4985 backend b_503
4986 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4987 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4988 # 503 error page to end users
4989
4990 backend be
4991 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4992 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4993 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4994 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4995 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4996
4997 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4998 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4999
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005000http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5001
5002 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5003 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5004 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5005 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005006 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5007 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005008
5009 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5010
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005011http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005012
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005013 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5014 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5015 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5016 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5017 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005018
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005019http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005020
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005021 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5022 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5023 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5024 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005025
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005026http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5027 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005028
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005029 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005030 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5031 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5032 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5033 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5034 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005035
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005036 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5037 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5038 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5039 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5040 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005041
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005042 Example:
5043 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5044
5045 # applied to:
5046 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5047
5048 # outputs:
5049 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5050
5051 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005052
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005053 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5054
5055 # applied to:
5056 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005057
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005058 # outputs:
5059 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005060
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005061http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5062 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5063
5064 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5065 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
5066 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
5067 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
5068
5069 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5070 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5071 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5072
5073 Example:
5074 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5075 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5076
5077 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5078 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5079
5080 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5081 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5082 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5083 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5084
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005085http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5086 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5087
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005088 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5089 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5090 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5091 against.
5092
5093 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5094 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5095 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005096
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005097 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5098 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5099 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5100 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5101 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5102 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5103 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5104 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5105 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005106 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5107 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005108
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005109 Example:
5110 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5111 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005112
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005113 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5114 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005115
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005116http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5117 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005118
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005119 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5120 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5121 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5122 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005123
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005124 Example:
5125 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005126
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005127 # applied to:
5128 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005129
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005130 # outputs:
5131 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005132
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005133http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5134 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5135 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005136 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005137 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5138
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005139 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005140 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5141 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
5142 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
5143 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005144 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005145 are followed to create the response :
5146
5147 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5148 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5149 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5150 ignored.
5151
5152 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5153 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
5154 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
5155 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5156 ignored.
5157
5158 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5159 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5160 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
5161 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
5162 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
5163
5164 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5165 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5166 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
5167 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
5168 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
5169 if any, is ignored.
5170
5171 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5172 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5173 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5174 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5175 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5176 as a raw content.
5177
5178 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5179 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5180 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5181 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5182 considered as a raw string.
5183
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005184 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5185 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5186 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5187 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5188
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005189 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5190 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
5191 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
5192
5193 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5194
5195 Example:
5196 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
5197 if { path /ping }
5198
5199 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
5200 if { path /favicon.ico }
5201
5202 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
5203 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
5204 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
5205
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005206http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5207http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005208
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005209 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5210 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5211 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005212
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005213http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5214 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005215
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005216 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5217 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5218 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5219 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005220
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005221http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005222
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005223 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
5224 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
5225 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
5226 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
5227 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005228
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005229 Arguments:
5230 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5231 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005232
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005233 Example:
5234 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
5235 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005236
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005237 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
5238 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005239
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005240http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005241
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005242 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
5243 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
5244 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005245
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005246 Arguments:
5247 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5248 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005249
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005250 Example:
5251 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
5252 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005253
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005254 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
5255 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
5256 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005257
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005258http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005259
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005260 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
5261 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5262 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5263 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5264 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005265
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005266 Example:
5267 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5268 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5269 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5270 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5271 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5272 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5273 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5274 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5275 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005276
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005277http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005278
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005279 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5280 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5281 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5282 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5283 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005284
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005285http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5286 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005287
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005288 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5289 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5290 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5291 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5292 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5293 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5294 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5295 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5296 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005297
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005298http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005299
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005300 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5301 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5302 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5303 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5304 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5305 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5306 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005307
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005308http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005309
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005310 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5311 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5312 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005313
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005314http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005315
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005316 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5317 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5318 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5319 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5320 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5321 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5322 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5323 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005324
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005325http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005326
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005327 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5328 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5329 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5330 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5331 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5332 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005333
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005334 Example :
5335 # prepend the host name before the path
5336 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005337
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005338http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005340 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5341 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5342 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5343 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5344 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005345
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005346http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005347
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005348 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5349 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5350 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5351 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5352 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5353 values have higher priority.
5354 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5355 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5356 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5357 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5358 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005359
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005360http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005361
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005362 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5363 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5364 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5365 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5366 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5367 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5368 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005369
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005370 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005371
5372 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005373 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5374 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005375
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005376http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5377 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5378 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5379 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005380 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
5381 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005382
5383 Arguments :
5384 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5385 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005386
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005387 See also "option forwardfor".
5388
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005389 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005390 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5391 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5392
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005393 # After the masking this will track connections
5394 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
5395 http-request track-sc0 src
5396
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005397 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5398 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5399
5400http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5401
5402 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5403 expression.
5404
5405 Arguments:
5406 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5407 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005408
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005409 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005410 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5411 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5412
5413 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5414 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5415 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5416
5417http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5418
5419 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5420 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5421 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5422 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5423 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5424 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5425 information from the request.
5426
5427 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5428
5429http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5430
5431 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5432 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5433 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5434 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5435 path and the query string.
5436 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5437
5438http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5439
5440 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5441 inline.
5442
5443 Arguments:
5444 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5445 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5446 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5447 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5448 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5449 (request and response)
5450 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5451 processing
5452 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5453 processing
5454 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5455 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
5456 and '_'.
5457
5458 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5459 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005460
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005461 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005462 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005463
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005464http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
5465 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005466
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005467 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5468 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5469 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5470 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5471 agent name must be used.
5472
5473 Arguments:
5474 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
5475
5476 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5477 configuration.
5478
5479http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5480
5481 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5482 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5483 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5484 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5485 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5486 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5487 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5488 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5489 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5490 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5491 action.
5492 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5493 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5494 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5495 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5496 you fully understand how it works.
5497
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005498http-request strict-mode { on | off }
5499
5500 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5501 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5502 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5503 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5504 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005505 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005506 processing.
5507
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005508 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005509 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5510 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
5511 rules evaluation.
5512
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005513http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5514 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005515
5516 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
5517 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
5518 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
5519 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
5520 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
5521 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
5522 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
5523 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
5524 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
5525 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
5526 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005527 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. A specific error
5528 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5529 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5530 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5531 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005532 See also the "silent-drop" action.
5533
5534http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5535http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5536http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5537
5538 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
5539 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
5540 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
5541 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
5542 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
5543 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5544 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
5545 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
5546 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5547 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
5548 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
5549 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
5550
5551 Arguments :
5552 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
5553 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
5554 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
5555 select which table entry to update the counters.
5556
5557 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
5558 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
5559 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
5560 that table until the session ends.
5561
5562 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
5563 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
5564 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
5565 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
5566 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
5567 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
5568 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
5569 useful information.
5570
5571 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
5572 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
5573 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
5574 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
5575 checks that make use of it.
5576
5577http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5578
5579 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005580
5581 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005582 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005583
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01005584http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5585
5586 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
5587 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5588 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5589 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5590 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5591 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5592
5593 Arguments :
5594 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5595
5596 Example:
5597 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5598
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005599http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005600
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005601 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5602 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5603 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005604
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005605
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005606http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005607 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5608
5609 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5610 no | yes | yes | yes
5611
5612 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5613 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5614 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5615 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5616 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5617 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5618
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005619 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5620 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005621
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005622 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005623
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005624 Example:
5625 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005626
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005627 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005628
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005629 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5630 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005631
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005632 Example:
5633 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005634
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005635 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005636
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005637 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5638 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005639
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005640 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5641 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005642
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005643http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005644
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005645 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5646 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5647 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5648 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5649 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5650 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5651 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5652 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005653
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005654http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005655
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005656 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5657 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5658 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5659 example, or to pass some internal information.
5660 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5661 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5662 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005663
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005664http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005665
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005666 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5667 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005668
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005669http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005670
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005671 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005672
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005673http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005674
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005675 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5676 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5677 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5678 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5679 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5680 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5681 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005682
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005683 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5684 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5685 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5686 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5687 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005688
5689 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5690 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5691 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5692 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005693
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005694http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005695
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005696 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5697 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5698 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5699 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5700 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5701 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005702
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005703http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005704
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005705 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005706
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005707http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005708
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005709 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5710 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5711 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5712 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5713 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5714 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005715
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005716http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5717 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005718
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005719 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005720 and emits an HTTP 502 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
5721 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005722 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
5723 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5724 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5725 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5726 followed by the section name.
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005727 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005728
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005729http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005730
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005731 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5732 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5733 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5734 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5735 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5736 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005737
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005738http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5739 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005740
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005741 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5742 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005743
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005744 Example:
5745 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005746
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005747 # applied to:
5748 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005749
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005750 # outputs:
5751 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005752
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005753 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005754
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005755http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5756 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005757
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01005758 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005759 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005760
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005761 Example:
5762 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005763
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005764 # applied to:
5765 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005766
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005767 # outputs:
5768 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005769
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005770http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5771 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5772 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005773 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005774 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5775
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005776 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005777 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5778 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
5779 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
5780 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005781 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005782 are followed to create the response :
5783
5784 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5785 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5786 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5787 ignored.
5788
5789 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5790 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
5791 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
5792 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5793 ignored.
5794
5795 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5796 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5797 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
5798 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
5799 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
5800
5801 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5802 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5803 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
5804 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
5805 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
5806 if any, is ignored.
5807
5808 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5809 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5810 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5811 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5812 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5813 as a raw content.
5814
5815 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5816 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5817 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5818 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5819 considered as a raw string.
5820
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005821 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5822 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5823 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5824 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5825
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005826 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5827 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
5828 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
5829
5830 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
5831
5832 Example:
5833 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
5834 if { status eq 404 }
5835
5836 http-response return content-type text/plain \
5837 string "This is the end !" \
5838 if { status eq 500 }
5839
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005840http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5841http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005842
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005843 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5844 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5845 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005846
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005847http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5848 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005849
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005850 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5851 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5852 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5853 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005854
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005855http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005856
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005857 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5858 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5859 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5860 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5861 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005862
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005863 Arguments:
5864 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005865
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005866 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5867 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005868
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005869http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005870
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005871 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5872 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5873 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005874
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005875http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5876
5877 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5878 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5879 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5880 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5881 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5882
5883http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5884
5885 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5886 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5887 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5888 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5889 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5890 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5891 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5892 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5893 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5894
5895http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5896
5897 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5898 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5899 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5900 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5901 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5902 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5903 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5904
5905http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5906
5907 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5908 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5909 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5910 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5911 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5912 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5913 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5914 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5915
5916http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5917 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5918
5919 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5920 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5921 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5922 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005923
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005924 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005925 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5926 http-response set-status 431
5927 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5928 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005929
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005930http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005931
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005932 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5933 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5934 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5935 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5936 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5937 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5938 based on some information from the request.
5939
5940 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5941
5942http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5943
5944 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5945 inline.
5946
5947 Arguments:
5948 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5949 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5950 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5951 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5952 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5953 (request and response)
5954 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5955 processing
5956 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5957 processing
5958 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5959 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5960 and '_'.
5961
5962 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5963 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005964
5965 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005966 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005967
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005968http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005969
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005970 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5971 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5972 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5973 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5974 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5975 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5976 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5977 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5978 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5979 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5980 action.
5981 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5982 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5983 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5984 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5985 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005986
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005987http-response strict-mode { on | off }
5988
5989 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5990 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5991 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5992 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5993 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005994 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005995 processing.
5996
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005997 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005998 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5999 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
6000 rules evaluation.
6001
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006002http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6003http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6004http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006005
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006006 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6007 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6008 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6009 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6010 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6011 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6012
6013http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6014
6015 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6016 about <var-name>.
6017
6018 Example:
6019 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6020
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006021
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006022http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6023 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6024
6025 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6026 yes | no | yes | yes
6027
6028 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006029 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6030 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6031 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006032
6033 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6034
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006035 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6036 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6037 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6038 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6039 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6040 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6041 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6042 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6043 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6044 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006045
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006046 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6047 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6048 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6049 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6050 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6051 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6052 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
6053 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006054
6055 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6056 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6057 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6058 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6059 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6060 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6061 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6062 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006063 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006064 downsides of rare connection failures.
6065
6066 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6067 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6068 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6069 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6070 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6071 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006072 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006073 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6074 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6075 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6076 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6077 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6078
6079 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006080 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6081 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6082 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006083
6084 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006085 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006086
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006087 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6088 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006089
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006090 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006091
6092 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6093 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6094 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6095
6096 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6097
6098
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006099http-send-name-header [<header>]
6100 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006101 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6102 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006103 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006104 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6105
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006106 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6107 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6108 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6109 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6110 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6111 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6112 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6113 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6114 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6115 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6116 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6117 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6118 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6119 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6120 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6121 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006122
6123 See also : "server"
6124
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006125id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006126 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6128 no | yes | yes | yes
6129 Arguments : none
6130
6131 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6132 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6133 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006134
6135
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006136ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6137 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6138 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006139 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006140
6141 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6142 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6143 and running).
6144
6145 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6146 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6147 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006148 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006149 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6150
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006151 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6152 "unless" condition is met.
6153
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006154 Example:
6155 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6156 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6157 ignore-persist if url_static
6158
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006159 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6160
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006161load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
6162 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
6163 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6164 yes | no | yes | yes
6165
6166 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
6167 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
6168 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006169 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006170 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
6171 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
6172 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
6173 over the stats socket and redirect output.
6174
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006175 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006176 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02006177 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006178
6179 Arguments:
6180 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
6181 named "server-state-file".
6182
6183 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
6184 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
6185 name is used as a file name.
6186
6187 none don't load any stat for this backend
6188
6189 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006190 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
6191 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
6192 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006193 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006194 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006195
6196 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
6197 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
6198
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006199 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006200
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006201 global
6202 stats socket /tmp/socket
6203 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006204
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006205 defaults
6206 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006207
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006208 backend bk
6209 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6210 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006211
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006212
6213 Then one can run :
6214
6215 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
6216
6217 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
6218
6219 1
6220 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6221 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6222 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6223
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006224 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006225
6226 global
6227 stats socket /tmp/socket
6228 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
6229
6230 defaults
6231 load-server-state-from-file local
6232
6233 backend bk
6234 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6235 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
6236
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006237
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006238 Then one can run :
6239
6240 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
6241
6242 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
6243
6244 1
6245 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6246 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6247 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6248
6249 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
6250 "show servers state"
6251
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006252
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006253log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006254log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
6255 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006256no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006257 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
6258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6259 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006260
6261 Prefix :
6262 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
6263 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
6264 prefix does not allow arguments.
6265
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006266 Arguments :
6267 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
6268 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
6269 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6270 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6271 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6272 parameter.
6273
6274 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6275 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6276
6277 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6278 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6279 standard syslog port).
6280
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006281 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6282 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6283 standard syslog port).
6284
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006285 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6286 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6287 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006288 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006289
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006290 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6291 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6292 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6293 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6294 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6295 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6296 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6297 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6298 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6299 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6300 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6301 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6302 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6303 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6304 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6305 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006306 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6307 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006308
6309 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6310 and "fd@2", see above.
6311
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006312 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6313 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6314 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6315 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6316 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6317 having the logs instantly available.
6318
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006319 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6320 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006321
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006322 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6323 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6324 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6325 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6326 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6327 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6328 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6329 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6330 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6331 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006332 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006333
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006334 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6335 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6336 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6337 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6338 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6339
6340 <sample_size>
6341 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6342 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6343 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6344 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6345 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6346
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006347 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6348 one of the following :
6349
6350 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6351 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6352
6353 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6354 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6355
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006356 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6357 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6358 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6359 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6360 systemd logger consumes.
6361
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006362 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6363 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6364 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6365 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6366
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006367 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6368
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006369 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6370 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6371 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6372
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006373 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6374 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6375 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6376 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006377
6378 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6379 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6380 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006381 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6382 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6383 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6384 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6385 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006386
6387 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6388
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006389 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6390 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6391 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006392
6393 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6394 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6395 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6396 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6397
6398 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6399 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006400
6401 Example :
6402 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006403 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6404 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6405 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006406 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
6407 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006408 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006409
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006410
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006411log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006412 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
6413 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6414 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006415
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006416 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
6417 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
6418 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
6419 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
6420 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006421
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006422 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
6423 "option httplog" directives.
6424
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02006425log-format-sd <string>
6426 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
6427 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6428 yes | yes | yes | no
6429
6430 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
6431 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
6432 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
6433 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
6434 which covers the log format string in depth.
6435
6436 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
6437 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
6438
6439 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
6440 log format to "rfc5424".
6441
6442 Example :
6443 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
6444
6445
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01006446log-tag <string>
6447 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
6448 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6449 yes | yes | yes | yes
6450
6451 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
6452 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
6453 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
6454 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
6455 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
6456 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
6457 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
6458 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
6459 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006460
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006461max-keep-alive-queue <value>
6462 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
6463 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6464 yes | no | yes | yes
6465
6466 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
6467 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
6468 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
6469 servers.
6470
6471 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
6472 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
6473 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
6474 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
6475 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006476 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006477 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
6478 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
6479 picking a different server.
6480
6481 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
6482 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
6483 even if they have to be queued.
6484
6485 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
6486 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
6487
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01006488max-session-srv-conns <nb>
6489 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
6490 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
6491 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006492
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006493maxconn <conns>
6494 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
6495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6496 yes | yes | yes | no
6497 Arguments :
6498 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
6499 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
6500 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
6501 closes.
6502
6503 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
6504 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
6505 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
6506 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01006507 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
6508 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
6509 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
6510 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006511
6512 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
6513 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
6514 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
6515
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01006516 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
6517 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02006518
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006519 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
6520
6521
6522mode { tcp|http|health }
6523 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
6524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6525 yes | yes | yes | yes
6526 Arguments :
6527 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
6528 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
6529 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
6530 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
6531
6532 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
6533 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
6534 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
6535 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
6536 brings HAProxy most of its value.
6537
6538 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006539 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
6540 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
6541 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
6542 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
6543 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
6544 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
6545 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006546
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006547 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
6548 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
6549 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006550
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006551 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006552 defaults http_instances
6553 mode http
6554
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006555 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006556
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006557
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006558monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006559 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6561 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006562 Arguments :
6563 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
6564 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006565 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006566 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
6567 backend and its backup.
6568
6569 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
6570 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
6571 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
6572 servers in a list of backends.
6573
6574 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
6575 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
6576 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
6577 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
6578 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
6579 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
6580 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006581 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
6582 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006583
6584 Example:
6585 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006586 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006587 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
6588 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
6589 monitor-uri /site_alive
6590 monitor fail if site_dead
6591
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006592 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006593
6594
6595monitor-net <source>
6596 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
6597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6598 yes | yes | yes | no
6599 Arguments :
6600 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
6601 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
6602 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
6603 followed by a mask.
6604
6605 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
6606 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006607 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006608 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
6609
6610 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
6611 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
6612 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
6613 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006614 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
6615 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
6616 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006617
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006618 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
6619 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
6620 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
6621 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
6622 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
6623 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006624
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01006625 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
6626 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006627
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006628 Example :
6629 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
6630 frontend www
6631 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
6632
6633 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
6634
6635
6636monitor-uri <uri>
6637 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
6638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6639 yes | yes | yes | no
6640 Arguments :
6641 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
6642 health status instead of forwarding the request.
6643
6644 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
6645 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
6646 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
6647 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
6648 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
6649 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
6650 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
6651 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
6652
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01006653 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006654 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
6655 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
6656 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
6657 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
6658 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
6659 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006660
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01006661 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
6662 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
6663 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
6664 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
6665
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006666 Example :
6667 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
6668 frontend www
6669 mode http
6670 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
6671
6672 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
6673
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006674
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006675option abortonclose
6676no option abortonclose
6677 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
6678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6679 yes | no | yes | yes
6680 Arguments : none
6681
6682 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
6683 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6684 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6685 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006686 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006687 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
6688 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6689 encountered while delivering the response.
6690
6691 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6692 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6693 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6694 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6695 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6696 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006697 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006698 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006699 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006700 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6701 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
6702 still not served and not pollute the servers.
6703
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006704 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
6705 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006706 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
6707 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6708 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6709 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6710 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6711 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006712 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006713
6714 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6715 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6716
6717 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6718
6719
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006720option accept-invalid-http-request
6721no option accept-invalid-http-request
6722 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
6723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6724 yes | yes | yes | no
6725 Arguments : none
6726
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006727 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006728 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006729 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006730 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6731 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6732 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6733 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6734 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006735 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
6736 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
6737 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
6738 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006739 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006740 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02006741 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
6742 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
6743 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006744
6745 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6746 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6747 been confirmed.
6748
6749 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6750 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006751 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6752 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006753 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6754
6755 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6756 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6757
6758 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6759 stats socket.
6760
6761
6762option accept-invalid-http-response
6763no option accept-invalid-http-response
6764 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6766 yes | no | yes | yes
6767 Arguments : none
6768
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006769 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006770 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006771 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006772 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6773 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6774 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6775 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6776 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006777 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6778 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6779 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006780
6781 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6782 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6783 been confirmed.
6784
6785 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6786 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6787 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6788 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6789
6790 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6791 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6792
6793 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6794 stats socket.
6795
6796
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006797option allbackups
6798no option allbackups
6799 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6801 yes | no | yes | yes
6802 Arguments : none
6803
6804 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6805 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6806 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6807 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6808 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6809 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6810 order between the backup servers anymore.
6811
6812 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6813 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6814
6815 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6816 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6817
6818
6819option checkcache
6820no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006821 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6823 yes | no | yes | yes
6824 Arguments : none
6825
6826 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6827 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006828 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006829 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6830 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006831 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006832
6833 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006834 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006835 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006836 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6837 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006838 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006839 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006840 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6841 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006842 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006843 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6844 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006845 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006846 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6847 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6848 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6849 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6850 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6851 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6852 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6853 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6854 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6855
6856 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006857 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
6858 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
6859 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
6860 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006861
6862 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6863 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006864 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006865 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006866
6867 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6868 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6869
6870
6871option clitcpka
6872no option clitcpka
6873 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6875 yes | yes | yes | no
6876 Arguments : none
6877
6878 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6879 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006880 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006881 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6882
6883 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6884 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6885 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6886 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6887
6888 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6889 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6890 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6891 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6892 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6893
6894 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6895
6896 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6897 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6898 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6899
6900 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6901 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6902
6903 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6904
6905
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006906option contstats
6907 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6909 yes | yes | yes | no
6910 Arguments : none
6911
6912 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6913 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6914 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6915 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006916 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6917 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6918 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6919 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6920 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006921
6922
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006923option dontlog-normal
6924no option dontlog-normal
6925 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6927 yes | yes | yes | no
6928 Arguments : none
6929
6930 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6931 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6932 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6933 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6934 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6935 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6936 logged.
6937
6938 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6939 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6940 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6941
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006942 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006943 logging.
6944
6945
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006946option dontlognull
6947no option dontlognull
6948 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6950 yes | yes | yes | no
6951 Arguments : none
6952
6953 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6954 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6955 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6956 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6957 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6958 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006959 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6960 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6961 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006962
6963 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006964 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006965 would not be logged.
6966
6967 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6968 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6969
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006970 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6971 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006972
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006973
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006974option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006975 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6977 yes | yes | yes | yes
6978 Arguments :
6979 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6980 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006981 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006982 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006983
6984 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6985 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6986 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6987 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6988 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6989 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6990 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006991 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6992 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6993 possible that the client has already brought one.
6994
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006995 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006996 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006997 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006998 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006999 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007000 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007001
7002 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7003 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7004 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7005 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7006 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7007 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7008 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7009
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007010 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7011 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7012 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7013 are under the control of the end-user.
7014
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007015 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007016 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7017 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007018 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7019 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7020 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007021
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007022 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007023 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7024 frontend www
7025 mode http
7026 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7027
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007028 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7029 backend www
7030 mode http
7031 option forwardfor header X-Client
7032
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007033 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007034 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007035
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007036
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007037option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7038no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7039 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7041 yes | yes | yes | no
7042 Arguments : none
7043
7044 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7045 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7046 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7047 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7048 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7049 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7050 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7051
7052 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7053 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7054 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7055 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7056 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7057 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7058 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7059 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7060 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7061 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7062
7063 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7064
7065 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7066 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7067
7068 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7069 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7070
7071
7072option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7073no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7074 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7076 yes | no | yes | yes
7077 Arguments : none
7078
7079 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7080 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7081 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7082 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7083 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7084 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7085 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7086
7087 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7088 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7089 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7090 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7091 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7092 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7093 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7094 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7095 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7096 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7097
7098 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7099
7100 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7101 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7102
7103 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7104 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7105
7106
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007107option http-buffer-request
7108no option http-buffer-request
7109 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7111 yes | yes | yes | yes
7112 Arguments : none
7113
7114 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7115 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7116 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7117 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7118 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7119 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007120 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7121 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7122 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7123 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007124
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007125 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007126
7127
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007128option http-ignore-probes
7129no option http-ignore-probes
7130 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7132 yes | yes | yes | no
7133 Arguments : none
7134
7135 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7136 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7137 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7138 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7139 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7140 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7141 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7142 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7143 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007144 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7145 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007146 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7147
7148 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7149 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7150 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7151 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7152 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7153 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7154 are often the only way to detect them.
7155
7156 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7157 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7158
7159 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7160
7161
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007162option http-keep-alive
7163no option http-keep-alive
7164 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7166 yes | yes | yes | yes
7167 Arguments : none
7168
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007169 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7170 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007171 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7172 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007173 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7174 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7175 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007176
7177 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
7178 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007179 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
7180 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
7181 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
7182 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
7183 situations where this option may be useful :
7184
7185 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007186 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007187
7188 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
7189 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
7190
7191 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
7192 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
7193 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
7194 request.
7195
7196 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
7197 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007198 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
7199 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
7200 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007201
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007202 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7203 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7204 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7205 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
7206 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7207 not set.
7208
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007209 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7210 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
7211 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007212
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007213 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007214 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01007215 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007216
7217
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007218option http-no-delay
7219no option http-no-delay
7220 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
7221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7222 yes | yes | yes | yes
7223 Arguments : none
7224
7225 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
7226 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
7227 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
7228 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
7229 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
7230 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
7231 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
7232 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
7233 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
7234 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
7235 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
7236 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
7237 affected.
7238
7239 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
7240 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
7241 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
7242 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
7243 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
7244 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
7245 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
7246 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
7247 latency environments.
7248
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007249 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7250
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007251
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007252option http-pretend-keepalive
7253no option http-pretend-keepalive
7254 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
7255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007256 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007257 Arguments : none
7258
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007259 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007260 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
7261 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
7262 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
7263 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
7264 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
7265 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
7266 consider the response complete.
7267
7268 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
7269 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7270 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7271 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007272 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007273 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7274
7275 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7276 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7277 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7278 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7279 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7280 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7281 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7282
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007283 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7284 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7285 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7286 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7287 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7288 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007289
7290 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7291 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7292
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007293 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007294 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007295
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007296
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007297option http-server-close
7298no option http-server-close
7299 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7301 yes | yes | yes | yes
7302 Arguments : none
7303
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007304 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7305 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7306 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7307 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007308 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7309 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7310 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7311 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7312 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7313 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7314 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7315 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7316 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7317 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7318 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007319
7320 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7321 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7322 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7323 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007324 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7325 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007326
7327 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7328 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007329 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7330 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7331 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007332
7333 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7334 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7335
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007336 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7337 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007338
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007339option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007340no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007341 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7343 yes | yes | yes | no
7344 Arguments : none
7345
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007346 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007347 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7348 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7349 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7350 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7351 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7352 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7353
7354 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7355 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007356 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7357 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7358 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007359
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007360 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7361 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7362 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7363 front of an existing proxy.
7364
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007365 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7366
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007367 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007368
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007369option httpchk
7370option httpchk <uri>
7371option httpchk <method> <uri>
7372option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007373 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7375 yes | no | yes | yes
7376 Arguments :
7377 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7378 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7379 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7380 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7381 ones.
7382
7383 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7384 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7385 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7386
7387 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7388 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7389 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007390 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007391
7392 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7393 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7394 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7395 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7396 the lack of any response.
7397
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007398 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
7399 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
7400 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
7401 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
7402
7403 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
7404 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
7405 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007406
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007407 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
7408 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007409 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
7410 internally relies on an HTX mutliplexer. Thus, it means the request
7411 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007412
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007413 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
7414 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
7415 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
7416 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
7417
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007418 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007419 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7420 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7421 backend https_relay
7422 mode tcp
7423 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
7424 http-check send hdr Host www
7425 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007426
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007427 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7428 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7429 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007430
7431
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007432option httpclose
7433no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007434 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7436 yes | yes | yes | yes
7437 Arguments : none
7438
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007439 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7440 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7441 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7442 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007443 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007444
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007445 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
7446 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05007447 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007448 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
7449 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007450
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007451 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
7452 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
7453 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007454
7455 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7456 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007457 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
7458 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7459 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007460
7461 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7462 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7463
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007464 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007465
7466
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007467option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007468 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
7469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007470 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007471 Arguments :
7472 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
7473 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
7474 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007475 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007476 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007477
7478 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7479 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7480 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
7481 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
7482 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
7483 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
7484 ports.
7485
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01007486 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
7487 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007488
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007489 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7490
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007491 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007492
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007493
7494option http_proxy
7495no option http_proxy
7496 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
7497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7498 yes | yes | yes | yes
7499 Arguments : none
7500
7501 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
7502 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
7503 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
7504 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
7505 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
7506
7507 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
7508 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007509 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
7510 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007511
7512 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7513 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7514
7515 Example :
7516 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
7517 backend direct_forward
7518 option httpclose
7519 option http_proxy
7520
7521 See also : "option httpclose"
7522
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007523
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007524option independent-streams
7525no option independent-streams
7526 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7528 yes | yes | yes | yes
7529 Arguments : none
7530
7531 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
7532 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
7533 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
7534 receive data or not.
7535
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007536 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007537 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
7538 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
7539 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
7540 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
7541 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
7542 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
7543 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
7544 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
7545 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
7546 socket buffers.
7547
7548 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
7549 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
7550 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
7551 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
7552 slow lines, so use it with caution.
7553
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007554 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007555
7556
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02007557option ldap-check
7558 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
7559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7560 yes | no | yes | yes
7561 Arguments : none
7562
7563 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
7564 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
7565 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
7566 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
7567
7568 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
7569 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
7570
7571 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
7572 configure it.
7573
7574 Example :
7575 option ldap-check
7576
7577 See also : "option httpchk"
7578
7579
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007580option external-check
7581 Use external processes for server health checks
7582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7583 yes | no | yes | yes
7584
7585 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
7586 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
7587 command".
7588
7589 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
7590
7591 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
7592
7593
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007594option log-health-checks
7595no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007596 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7598 yes | no | yes | yes
7599 Arguments : none
7600
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007601 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
7602 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
7603 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007604
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007605 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
7606 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
7607 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
7608 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
7609 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
7610
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007611 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007612 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007613
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007614 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7615 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7616 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007617
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007618
7619option log-separate-errors
7620no option log-separate-errors
7621 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7623 yes | yes | yes | no
7624 Arguments : none
7625
7626 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
7627 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
7628 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
7629 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
7630 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
7631 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
7632 provides very important information.
7633
7634 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
7635 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
7636 error logs.
7637
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007638 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007639 logging.
7640
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007641
7642option logasap
7643no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007644 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7646 yes | yes | yes | no
7647 Arguments : none
7648
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007649 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
7650 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
7651 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
7652 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
7653
7654 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
7655 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
7656 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
7657 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
7658 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
7659 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transfered
7660 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
7661 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
7662 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
7663 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
7664 transfered.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007665
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007666 Examples :
7667 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
7668 mode http
7669 option httplog
7670 option logasap
7671 log 192.168.2.200 local3
7672
7673 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7674 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7675 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
7676 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
7677
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007678 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007679 logging.
7680
7681
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007682option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007683 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7685 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007686 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007687 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
7688 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007689 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007690
7691 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7692 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007693 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007694 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7695 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7696 in the MySQL table, like this :
7697
7698 USE mysql;
7699 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7700 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7701
7702 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007703 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007704 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7705 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7706 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7707 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7708 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7709 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7710 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7711
7712 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7713 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007714
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007715 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007716
7717 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7718 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7719 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7720 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007721 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7722 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007723
7724 See also: "option httpchk"
7725
7726
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007727option nolinger
7728no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007729 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007730 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7731 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007732 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007733
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007734 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007735 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7736 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7737 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7738 connections.
7739
7740 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7741 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7742 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7743 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7744 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7745 this too.
7746
7747 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7748 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7749 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7750
7751 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7752 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7753 for servers.
7754
7755 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7756 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7757
7758
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007759option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7760 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7762 yes | yes | yes | yes
7763 Arguments :
7764 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7765 matching <network>
7766 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7767 header name.
7768
7769 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7770 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7771 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7772 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7773 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7774 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7775 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7776 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7777 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7778 possible that the client has already brought one.
7779
7780 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7781 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7782 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7783 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7784 header and requires different one.
7785
7786 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7787 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7788 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7789 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7790 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7791 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7792 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7793
7794 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7795 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7796 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7797 both are defined.
7798
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007799 Examples :
7800 # Original Destination address
7801 frontend www
7802 mode http
7803 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7804
7805 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7806 backend www
7807 mode http
7808 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7809
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007810 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007811
7812
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007813option persist
7814no option persist
7815 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7816 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7817 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007818 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007819
7820 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7821 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7822 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7823 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7824 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7825 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7826 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7827 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7828 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7829 redirected to another valid server.
7830
7831 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7832 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7833
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007834 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007835
7836
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007837option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7838 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7840 yes | no | yes | yes
7841 Arguments :
7842 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7843 PostgreSQL server.
7844
7845 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7846 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7847 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7848 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7849
7850 See also: "option httpchk"
7851
7852
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007853option prefer-last-server
7854no option prefer-last-server
7855 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7856 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7857 yes | no | yes | yes
7858 Arguments : none
7859
7860 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7861 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7862 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7863 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7864 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7865 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7866 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7867 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7868 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007869 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7870 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007871 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7872 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7873 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007874 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7875 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7876 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007877
7878 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7879 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7880
7881 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7882
7883
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007884option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007885option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007886no option redispatch
7887 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7888 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7889 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007890 Arguments :
7891 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7892 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7893 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007894 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007895 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007896 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007897 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7898 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7899 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7900
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007901
7902 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7903 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7904 be able to access the service anymore.
7905
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007906 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7907 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007908
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02007909 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
7910 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
7911 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
7912 following order:
7913
7914 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
7915
7916 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
7917 list, or
7918
7919 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
7920
7921 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
7922 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
7923
7924 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
7925 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
7926 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
7927 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
7928
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007929 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007930 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7931 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007932
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007933 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7934 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7935
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007936 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007937
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007938
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007939option redis-check
7940 Use redis health checks for server testing
7941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7942 yes | no | yes | yes
7943 Arguments : none
7944
7945 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7946 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7947 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7948 find the "+PONG" response message.
7949
7950 Example :
7951 option redis-check
7952
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007953 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007954
7955
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007956option smtpchk
7957option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7958 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7960 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007961 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007962 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007963 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007964 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7965
7966 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7967 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7968 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7969
7970 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7971 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7972 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7973 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7974 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7975 dead server.
7976
7977 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7978 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007979 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007980 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7981
7982 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7983 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7984 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7985 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007986 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007987
7988 Example :
7989 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7990
7991 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7992
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007993
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007994option socket-stats
7995no option socket-stats
7996
7997 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7999 yes | yes | yes | no
8000
8001 Arguments : none
8002
8003
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008004option splice-auto
8005no option splice-auto
8006 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8008 yes | yes | yes | yes
8009 Arguments : none
8010
8011 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8012 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008013 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008014 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008015 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008016 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8017 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8018 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8019 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8020
8021 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8022 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8023 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8024 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8025 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8026 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8027 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8028 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8029 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8030 keyword.
8031
8032 Example :
8033 option splice-auto
8034
8035 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8036 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8037
8038 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8039 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8040
8041
8042option splice-request
8043no option splice-request
8044 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8046 yes | yes | yes | yes
8047 Arguments : none
8048
8049 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008050 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008051 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8052 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8053 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8054 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8055
8056 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8057
8058 Example :
8059 option splice-request
8060
8061 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8062 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8063
8064 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8065 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8066
8067
8068option splice-response
8069no option splice-response
8070 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8072 yes | yes | yes | yes
8073 Arguments : none
8074
8075 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008076 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008077 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8078 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8079 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8080 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8081
8082 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8083
8084 Example :
8085 option splice-response
8086
8087 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8088 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8089
8090 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8091 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8092
8093
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008094option spop-check
8095 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8097 no | no | no | yes
8098 Arguments : none
8099
8100 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8101 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8102 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8103 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8104
8105 Example :
8106 option spop-check
8107
8108 See also : "option httpchk"
8109
8110
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008111option srvtcpka
8112no option srvtcpka
8113 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8115 yes | no | yes | yes
8116 Arguments : none
8117
8118 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8119 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008120 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008121 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8122
8123 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8124 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8125 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8126 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8127
8128 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8129 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8130 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8131 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8132 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8133
8134 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8135
8136 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8137 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8138 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8139
8140 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8141 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8142
8143 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8144
8145
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008146option ssl-hello-chk
8147 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8149 yes | no | yes | yes
8150 Arguments : none
8151
8152 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8153 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8154 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8155 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8156 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8157 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8158 hello message.
8159
8160 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
8161 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
8162 messages, which is appreciable.
8163
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008164 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
8165 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
8166 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008167
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008168 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
8169
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008170
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008171option tcp-check
8172 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
8173 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8174 yes | no | yes | yes
8175
8176 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
8177 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
8178
8179 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
8180 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
8181 attempt, which remains the default mode.
8182
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008183 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008184 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
8185 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
8186 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
8187 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
8188 only.
8189
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008190 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008191 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
8192 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
8193 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
8194 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
8195
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008196 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008197 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
8198 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008199 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008200 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
8201 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
8202 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
8203 the respective protocols.
8204 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008205 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008206
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008207 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008208
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008209 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
8210 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
8211 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
8212 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008213
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008214 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
8215 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
8216 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01008217
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008218
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008219 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008220 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008221 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008222 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008223
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008224 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008225 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008226 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008227
8228 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
8229 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008230 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008231 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008232 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008233 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008234 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008235 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008236 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8237 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008238 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008239 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8240 tcp-check expect string +OK
8241
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008242 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008243 (send many headers before analyzing)
8244 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008245 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008246 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
8247 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
8248 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
8249 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008250 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008251
8252
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008253 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008254
8255
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008256option tcp-smart-accept
8257no option tcp-smart-accept
8258 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
8259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8260 yes | yes | yes | no
8261 Arguments : none
8262
8263 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
8264 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
8265 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
8266 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
8267 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
8268 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
8269
8270 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
8271 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
8272 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
8273 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
8274
8275 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
8276 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
8277 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008278 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008279
8280 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
8281 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
8282 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
8283
8284 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
8285 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
8286 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
8287
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02008288 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
8289
8290
8291option tcp-smart-connect
8292no option tcp-smart-connect
8293 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8295 yes | no | yes | yes
8296 Arguments : none
8297
8298 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8299 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8300 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8301 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8302 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8303
8304 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8305 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8306 complex.
8307
8308 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8309 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8310 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8311
8312 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8313 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8314
8315 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8316
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008317
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008318option tcpka
8319 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8321 yes | yes | yes | yes
8322 Arguments : none
8323
8324 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8325 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008326 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008327 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8328
8329 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8330 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8331 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8332 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8333
8334 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8335 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8336 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8337 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8338 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8339
8340 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8341
8342 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8343 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8344 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8345 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8346 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8347 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8348 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8349 backends.
8350
8351 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8352
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008353
8354option tcplog
8355 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008357 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008358 Arguments : none
8359
8360 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8361 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8362 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8363 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8364 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8365 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8366 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8367 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8368
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008369 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8370
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008371 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008372
8373
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008374option transparent
8375no option transparent
8376 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008378 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008379 Arguments : none
8380
8381 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8382 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8383 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8384 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8385 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8386 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8387 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8388 appropriate server.
8389
8390 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8391 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8392
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008393 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008394 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008395
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008396
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008397external-check command <command>
8398 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8400 yes | no | yes | yes
8401
8402 Arguments :
8403 <command> is the external command to run
8404
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008405 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8406
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008407 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008408
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008409 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8410 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8411 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8412 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8413 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8414 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008415
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008416 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8417
8418 Environment variables :
8419 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
8420 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
8421
8422 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
8423
8424 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
8425
8426 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
8427 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
8428 for a UNIX socket).
8429
8430 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
8431
8432 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
8433
8434 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
8435
8436 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
8437
8438 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
8439
8440 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
8441 socket).
8442
8443 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
8444 the command may be set using "external-check path".
8445
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02008446 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
8447
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008448 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
8449 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
8450 failed.
8451
8452 Example :
8453 external-check command /bin/true
8454
8455 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
8456
8457
8458external-check path <path>
8459 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
8460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8461 yes | no | yes | yes
8462
8463 Arguments :
8464 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
8465
8466 The default path is "".
8467
8468 Example :
8469 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
8470
8471 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
8472 "external-check command"
8473
8474
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008475persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008476persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008477 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
8478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8479 yes | no | yes | yes
8480 Arguments :
8481 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008482 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
8483 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008484
8485 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
8486 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008487 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008488 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
8489 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
8490 forwarded to this server.
8491
8492 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
8493 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
8494 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008495 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008496 a single "listen" section.
8497
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008498 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
8499 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
8500 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
8501
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008502 Example :
8503 listen tse-farm
8504 bind :3389
8505 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8506 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8507 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8508 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8509 persist rdp-cookie
8510 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008511 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008512 balance rdp-cookie
8513 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8514 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
8515
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008516 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
8517 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008518
8519
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008520rate-limit sessions <rate>
8521 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
8522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8523 yes | yes | yes | no
8524 Arguments :
8525 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
8526 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
8527
8528 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
8529 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
8530 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
8531 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
8532 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
8533 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
8534
8535 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
8536 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
8537 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
8538 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
8539
8540 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
8541 listen smtp
8542 mode tcp
8543 bind :25
8544 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02008545 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008546
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02008547 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
8548 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
8549 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008550
8551 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
8552
8553
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008554redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8555redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8556redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008557 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
8558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8559 no | yes | yes | yes
8560
8561 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01008562 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008563
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008564 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008565 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008566 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
8567 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
8568 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008569
8570 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
8571 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
8572 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
8573 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
8574 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008575 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
8576 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
8577 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
8578 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008579
8580 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
8581 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
8582 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
8583 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
8584 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
8585 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008586 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008587 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008588 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
8589 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
8590 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008591
8592 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008593 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
8594 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
8595 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02008596 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008597 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
8598 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
8599 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
8600 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008601
8602 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008603 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008604
8605 - "drop-query"
8606 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
8607 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
8608 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
8609 with a location-type redirect.
8610
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008611 - "append-slash"
8612 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
8613 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
8614 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
8615 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
8616
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008617 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
8618 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
8619 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
8620 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
8621 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
8622 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
8623 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
8624
8625 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
8626 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
8627 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
8628 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
8629 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
8630 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
8631 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008632
8633 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
8634 acl clear dst_port 80
8635 acl secure dst_port 8080
8636 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008637 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008638 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008639 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
8640
8641 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008642 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
8643 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
8644 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008645 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008646
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008647 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
8648 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
8649 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
8650
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008651 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01008652 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008653
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008654 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02008655 http-request redirect code 301 location \
8656 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
8657 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008658
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008659 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008660
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008661
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008662retries <value>
8663 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8664 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8665 yes | no | yes | yes
8666 Arguments :
8667 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8668 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8669 default value is 3.
8670
8671 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8672 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8673 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8674
8675 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008676 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8677 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008678
8679 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8680 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8681
8682 See also : "option redispatch"
8683
8684
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008685retry-on [list of keywords]
8686 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8687 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8688 yes | no | yes | yes
8689 Arguments :
8690 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8691 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8692 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8693 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8694
8695 none never retry
8696
8697 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8698 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8699
8700 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8701 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8702 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8703 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8704 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8705 processing the request.
8706
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008707 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8708 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8709 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8710 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8711 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8712 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8713 overflow attack for example).
8714
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008715 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8716 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8717 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8718 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8719 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8720 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8721 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8722 amplify denial of service attacks.
8723
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008724 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8725 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8726 considered to be safe to retry.
8727
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008728 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8729 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8730 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8731 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8732
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008733 all-retryable-errors
8734 retry request for any error that are considered
8735 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8736 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8737 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8738
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008739 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8740 not cumulative.
8741
8742 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8743 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8744 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8745 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8746
8747 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8748 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8749 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8750 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8751 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8752 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8753 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8754 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8755 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8756 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8757 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8758 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8759
8760 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8761 should not use this directive.
8762
8763 The default is "conn-failure".
8764
8765 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8766
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008767server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008768 Declare a server in a backend
8769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8770 no | no | yes | yes
8771 Arguments :
8772 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008773 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008774 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008775
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008776 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8777 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8778 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8779 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008780 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8781 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8782 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8783 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8784 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008785 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8786 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8787 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8788 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8789 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8790 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8791 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008792 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008793 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8794 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8795 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8796 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8797 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8798 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008799 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8800 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008801 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8802 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008803
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008804 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008805 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8806 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8807 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8808 adding this value to the client's port.
8809
8810 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8811 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008812 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008813
8814 Examples :
8815 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8816 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008817 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008818 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8819 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8820 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008821
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008822 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8823 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8824 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8825 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8826 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8827
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008828 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8829 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008830
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008831server-state-file-name [<file>]
8832 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8833 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8834 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8835 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8836 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8837 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8838
8839 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8840 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8841
8842 global
8843 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8844
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01008845 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008846 load-server-state-from-file
8847
8848 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8849 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008850
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008851server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8852 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8853 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8855 no | no | yes | yes
8856
8857 Arguments:
8858 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8859
8860 <num | range>
8861 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8862 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8863 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8864 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8865
8866 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8867
8868 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8869
8870 <params*>
8871 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8872 keyword.
8873
8874 Examples:
8875 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8876 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8877 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8878
8879 # or
8880 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8881
8882 # would be equivalent to:
8883 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8884 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8885 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8886
8887
8888
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008889source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008890source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008891source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008892 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8894 yes | no | yes | yes
8895 Arguments :
8896 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8897 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008898
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008899 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008900 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8901 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8902 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8903 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8904 supported prefixes are :
8905 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8906 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8907 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008908 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008909 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8910 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008911
8912 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8913 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008914 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8915 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8916 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008917
8918 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8919 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8920 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8921 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8922 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8923 <addr>.
8924
8925 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8926 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8927 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8928 port.
8929
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008930 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8931 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8932 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8933 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008934 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008935 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8936 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8937 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8938 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8939 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8940 HTTP header.
8941
8942 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8943 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008944 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008945 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8946 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8947 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8948 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8949 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8950 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8951 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8952
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008953 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8954 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8955 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8956 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8957 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8958 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8959
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008960 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8961 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8962 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8963 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8964
8965 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8966 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8967 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8968 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8969 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8970 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8971
8972 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8973 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8974 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8975 there are two methods :
8976
8977 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8978 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8979 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8980 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8981 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8982 of the client ranges may be used.
8983
8984 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8985 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8986 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8987 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8988 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8989 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8990 same session.
8991
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008992 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8993 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8994 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008995 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008996
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008997 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8998
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008999 Examples :
9000 backend private
9001 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9002 source 192.168.1.200
9003
9004 backend transparent_ssl1
9005 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9006 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9007
9008 backend transparent_ssl2
9009 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9010 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9011 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9012
9013 backend transparent_ssl3
9014 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9015 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9016 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9017
9018 backend transparent_smtp
9019 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9020 # with Tproxy version 4.
9021 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9022
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009023 backend transparent_http
9024 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9025 # proxy.
9026 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9027
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009028 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009029 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9030
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009031
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009032stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9033 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009035 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009036
9037 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9038 matched.
9039
9040 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9041 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9042
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009043 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9044 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009045 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009046
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009047 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9048 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9049 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9050 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009051
9052 Example :
9053 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9054 backend stats_localhost
9055 stats enable
9056 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9057
9058 Example :
9059 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9060 backend stats_auth
9061 stats enable
9062 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9063 stats admin if TRUE
9064
9065 Example :
9066 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9067 userlist stats-auth
9068 group admin users admin
9069 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9070 group readonly users haproxy
9071 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9072
9073 backend stats_auth
9074 stats enable
9075 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9076 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9077 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9078 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9079
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009080 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9081 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9082 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009083
9084
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009085stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9086 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009088 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009089 Arguments :
9090 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9091
9092 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9093
9094 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9095 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9096 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9097 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9098 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9099 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9100
9101 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9102 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
9103 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009104 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009105
9106 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
9107 report using "stats scope".
9108
9109 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9110 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9111 unobvious parameters.
9112
9113 Example :
9114 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9115 backend public_www
9116 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9117 stats enable
9118 stats hide-version
9119 stats scope .
9120 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009121 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009122 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9123 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9124
9125 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9126 backend private_monitoring
9127 stats enable
9128 stats uri /admin?stats
9129 stats refresh 5s
9130
9131 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
9132
9133
9134stats enable
9135 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
9136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009137 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009138 Arguments : none
9139
9140 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
9141 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
9142 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
9143 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
9144 - stats auth : no authentication
9145 - stats scope : no restriction
9146
9147 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9148 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9149 unobvious parameters.
9150
9151 Example :
9152 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9153 backend public_www
9154 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9155 stats enable
9156 stats hide-version
9157 stats scope .
9158 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009159 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009160 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9161 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9162
9163 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9164 backend private_monitoring
9165 stats enable
9166 stats uri /admin?stats
9167 stats refresh 5s
9168
9169 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9170
9171
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009172stats hide-version
9173 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009175 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009176 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009177
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009178 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
9179 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
9180 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
9181 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
9182 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
9183 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009184
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009185 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9186 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9187 unobvious parameters.
9188
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009189 Example :
9190 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9191 backend public_www
9192 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009193 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009194 stats hide-version
9195 stats scope .
9196 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009197 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009198 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9199 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009200
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009201 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9202 backend private_monitoring
9203 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009204 stats uri /admin?stats
9205 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009206
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009207 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009208
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009209
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009210stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9211 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9212 Access control for statistics
9213
9214 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9215 no | no | yes | yes
9216
9217 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9218 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9219 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9220 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9221 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9222 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9223
9224 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9225 instance.
9226
9227 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9228 about ACL usage.
9229
9230
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009231stats realm <realm>
9232 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009234 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009235 Arguments :
9236 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9237 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9238 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9239
9240 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9241 using a backslash ('\').
9242
9243 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9244 only related to authentication.
9245
9246 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9247 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9248 unobvious parameters.
9249
9250 Example :
9251 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9252 backend public_www
9253 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9254 stats enable
9255 stats hide-version
9256 stats scope .
9257 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009258 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009259 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9260 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9261
9262 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9263 backend private_monitoring
9264 stats enable
9265 stats uri /admin?stats
9266 stats refresh 5s
9267
9268 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9269
9270
9271stats refresh <delay>
9272 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009274 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009275 Arguments :
9276 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9277 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9278 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9279 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9280 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9281 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9282
9283 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9284 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9285 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9286 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9287
9288 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9289 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9290 unobvious parameters.
9291
9292 Example :
9293 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9294 backend public_www
9295 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9296 stats enable
9297 stats hide-version
9298 stats scope .
9299 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009300 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009301 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9302 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9303
9304 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9305 backend private_monitoring
9306 stats enable
9307 stats uri /admin?stats
9308 stats refresh 5s
9309
9310 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9311
9312
9313stats scope { <name> | "." }
9314 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9315 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009316 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009317 Arguments :
9318 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9319 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9320 section in which the statement appears.
9321
9322 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9323 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9324 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9325 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9326 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9327 exists.
9328
9329 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9330 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9331 unobvious parameters.
9332
9333 Example :
9334 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9335 backend public_www
9336 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9337 stats enable
9338 stats hide-version
9339 stats scope .
9340 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009341 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009342 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9343 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9344
9345 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9346 backend private_monitoring
9347 stats enable
9348 stats uri /admin?stats
9349 stats refresh 5s
9350
9351 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9352
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009353
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009354stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009355 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009357 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009358
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009359 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009360 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9361
9362 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9363 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9364
9365 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9366 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009367 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009368
9369 Example :
9370 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9371 backend private_monitoring
9372 stats enable
9373 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9374 stats uri /admin?stats
9375 stats refresh 5s
9376
9377 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9378 global section.
9379
9380
9381stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009382 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9384 yes | yes | yes | yes
9385 Arguments : none
9386
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009387 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009388 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9389 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9390 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9391 - IP (socket, server)
9392 - cookie (backend, server)
9393
9394 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9395 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009396 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009397
9398 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9399
9400
9401stats show-node [ <name> ]
9402 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009404 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009405 Arguments:
9406 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9407 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9408
9409 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9410 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009411 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009412
9413 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9414 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9415 unobvious parameters.
9416
9417 Example:
9418 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9419 backend private_monitoring
9420 stats enable
9421 stats show-node Europe-1
9422 stats uri /admin?stats
9423 stats refresh 5s
9424
9425 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9426 section.
9427
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009428
9429stats uri <prefix>
9430 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9431 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009432 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009433 Arguments :
9434 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9435 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9436 query string.
9437
9438 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9439 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9440 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9441 possible to reach it in the application.
9442
9443 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009444 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009445 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9446 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9447 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9448 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9449
9450 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9451 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9452 an address or a port to statistics only.
9453
9454 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9455 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9456 unobvious parameters.
9457
9458 Example :
9459 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9460 backend public_www
9461 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9462 stats enable
9463 stats hide-version
9464 stats scope .
9465 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009466 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009467 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9468 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9469
9470 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9471 backend private_monitoring
9472 stats enable
9473 stats uri /admin?stats
9474 stats refresh 5s
9475
9476 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9477
9478
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009479stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9480 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009482 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009483
9484 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009485 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009486 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009487 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009488 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9489
9490 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9491 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9492 the "stick-table" statement.
9493
9494 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9495 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9496 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9497 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9498 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9499
9500 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9501 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9502 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9503 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9504 transformation rules.
9505
9506 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9507 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9508 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9509 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9510 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9511 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9512 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9513
9514 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9515 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9516 ACL based conditions.
9517
9518 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9519 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9520 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9521 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9522
9523 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9524 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9525 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9526 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9527
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009528 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9529 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009530 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009531
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009532 Example :
9533 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9534 # last 30 minutes
9535 backend pop
9536 mode tcp
9537 balance roundrobin
9538 stick store-request src
9539 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9540 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9541 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9542
9543 backend smtp
9544 mode tcp
9545 balance roundrobin
9546 stick match src table pop
9547 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9548 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9549
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009550 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009551 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009552
9553
9554stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9555 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9557 no | no | yes | yes
9558
9559 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9560 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9561 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9562 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9563
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009564 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9565 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009566 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009567
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009568 Examples :
9569 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009570 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009571
9572 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9573 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9574 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9575
9576
9577 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9578 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9579 backend http
9580 mode http
9581 balance roundrobin
9582 stick on src table https
9583 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9584 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9585 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9586
9587 backend https
9588 mode tcp
9589 balance roundrobin
9590 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9591 stick on src
9592 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9593 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9594
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009595 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009596
9597
9598stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9599 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9601 no | no | yes | yes
9602
9603 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009604 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009605 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009606 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009607 server is selected.
9608
9609 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9610 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9611 the "stick-table" statement.
9612
9613 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9614 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9615 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9616 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9617 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9618 address.
9619
9620 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9621 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9622 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9623 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9624 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9625 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9626 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9627 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9628 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9629 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9630
9631 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9632 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9633 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9634 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9635 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9636 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9637 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9638
9639 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9640 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9641 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9642 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9643
9644 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9645 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9646 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9647 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9648 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9649 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009650 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9651 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9652 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9653 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9654 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9655 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009656
9657 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9658 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9659 the request.
9660
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009661 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9662 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009663 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009664
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009665 Example :
9666 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9667 # last 30 minutes
9668 backend pop
9669 mode tcp
9670 balance roundrobin
9671 stick store-request src
9672 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9673 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9674 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9675
9676 backend smtp
9677 mode tcp
9678 balance roundrobin
9679 stick match src table pop
9680 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9681 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9682
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009683 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009684 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009685
9686
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009687stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009688 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9689 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009690 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009692 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009693
9694 Arguments :
9695 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9696 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9697 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9698 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9699
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009700 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9701 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9702 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9703 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9704
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009705 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9706 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9707 instance.
9708
9709 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9710 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9711 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9712 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9713 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9714 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009715 to 32 characters.
9716
9717 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9718 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9719 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009720 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009721 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9722 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009723
9724 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009725 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9726 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009727 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9728 increase.
9729
9730 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009731 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9732 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9733 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009734
9735 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9736 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9737 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9738 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009739 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009740 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9741 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9742 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9743 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9744 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9745 parameter (see below).
9746
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009747 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9748 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9749 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9750 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9751 soft restart.
9752
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009753 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9754 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009755
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009756 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9757 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9758 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9759 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009760 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009761 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009762 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9763 if not expiration delay is specified.
9764
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009765 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9766 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9767 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9768 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009769 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9770 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9771 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9772 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9773 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9774 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9775 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9776 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9777 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9778 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9779 types and their arguments.
9780
9781 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9782 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9783 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9784 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9785
9786 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9787 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9788 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009789 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009790
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009791 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9792 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9793 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009794 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009795 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009796 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009797
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009798 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9799 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9800 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9801 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9802
9803 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9804 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9805 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9806 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9807 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9808 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9809
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009810 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9811 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9812 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9813 they were received.
9814
9815 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9816 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9817 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9818 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9819 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9820
9821 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9822 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9823 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9824 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9825 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9826
9827 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9828 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9829 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9830
9831 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9832 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9833 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9834 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9835 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9836
9837 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9838 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9839 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9840 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9841 the client side.
9842
9843 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9844 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9845 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9846 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9847 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9848 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9849 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9850
9851 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9852 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9853 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9854 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9855 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9856 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009857 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009858
9859 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9860 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9861 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9862 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9863 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9864 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9865
9866 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009867 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009868 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9869 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9870
9871 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9872 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9873 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9874 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9875 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9876 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9877 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9878 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9879 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9880 recommended for better fairness.
9881
9882 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009883 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009884 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9885 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9886
9887 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9888 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9889 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9890 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9891 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9892 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9893 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9894 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9895 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9896 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009897
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009898 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9899 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009900 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9901 reference it.
9902
9903 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9904 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009905 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9906 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9907 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009908
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009909 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9910 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9911 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9912 something that can be ignored.
9913
9914 Example:
9915 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9916 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9917 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9918 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9919
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009920 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009921 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009922
9923
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009924stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009925 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9927 no | no | yes | yes
9928
9929 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009930 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009931 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009932 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009933 server is selected.
9934
9935 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9936 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9937 the "stick-table" statement.
9938
9939 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9940 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9941 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9942 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9943
9944 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9945 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9946 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9947 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9948 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9949 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009950 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009951 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9952 rules.
9953
9954 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9955 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9956 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9957 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9958 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9959 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9960 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9961
9962 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9963 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9964 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9965 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9966
9967 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9968 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9969 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9970 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9971 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9972 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009973 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9974 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9975 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9976 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9977 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9978 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9979 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9980 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9981 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009982
9983 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9984
9985 Example :
9986 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9987 backend https
9988 mode tcp
9989 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009990 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009991 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009992
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009993 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9994 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9995
9996 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9997 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9998 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9999
10000 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10001 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010002
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010003 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10004 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10005 # at offset 44.
10006
10007 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10008 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10009
10010 # Learn on response if server hello.
10011 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010012
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010013 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10014 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10015
10016 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10017 extraction.
10018
10019
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010020tcp-check comment <string>
10021 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10022 it fails.
10023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10024 yes | no | yes | yes
10025
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010026 Arguments :
10027 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10028 rule fails.
10029
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010030 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10031 user-friendly error reporting.
10032
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010033 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10034 "tcp-check expect".
10035
10036
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010037tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10038 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010039 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010040 Opens a new connection
10041 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010042 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010043
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010044 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010045 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10046
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010047 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Christopher Fauletbb591a12020-04-01 16:52:17 +020010048 checks. The server options are used only if not redifined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010049
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010050 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010051 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10052 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010053 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010054
10055 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010056
10057 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10058
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010059 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10060
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010061 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10062
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010063 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10064
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010065 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10066 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10067 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10068 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10069
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010070 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
10071 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
10072 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
10073 haproxy -vv.
10074
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010075 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010076
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010077 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
10078 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
10079 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
10080
10081 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
10082 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10083 of the sequence.
10084
10085 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10086 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
10087 do.
10088
10089 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
10090 unset-var or comment rules.
10091
10092 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010093 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
10094 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
10095 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
10096 option tcp-check
10097 tcp-check connect
10098 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10099 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10100 tcp-check send \r\n
10101 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10102 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
10103 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10104 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10105 tcp-check send \r\n
10106 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10107 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
10108
10109 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
10110 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010111 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010112 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10113 tcp-check connect port 143
10114 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10115 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
10116
10117 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
10118
10119
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010120tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010121 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010122 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010123 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010124 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010125 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010126 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010127
10128 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010129 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10130
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010131 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
10132 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
10133 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
10134 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
10135 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
10136 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
10137 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
10138 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
10139 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
10140 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
10141
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010142 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010143 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
10144 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010145 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
10146 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
10147 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
10148
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010149 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10150 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
10151 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
10152 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported and may be used to set,
10153 respectively, HCHK_STATUS_L7OK, HCHK_STATUS_L7OKCD,
10154 HCHK_STATUS_L6OK or HCHK_STATUS_L4OK success status.
10155 By default "L7OK" is used.
10156
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010157 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10158 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
10159 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported and
10160 may be used to set, respectively, HCHK_STATUS_L7RSP,
10161 HCHK_STATUS_L7STS, HCHK_STATUS_L6RSP or HCHK_STATUS_L4CON
10162 error status. By default "L7RSP" is used.
10163
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010164 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010165 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
10166 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported and may
10167 be used to set, respectively, HCHK_STATUS_L7TOUT,
10168 HCHK_STATUS_L6TOUT or HCHK_STATUS_L4TOUT timeout status.
10169 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
10170
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020010171 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10172 informational message reported in logs if the expect
10173 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
10174 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
10175
10176 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10177 informational message reported in logs if an error
10178 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
10179 log-format string.
10180
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010181 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
10182 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
10183 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10184 followed by some converters.
10185
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010186 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
10187 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
10188 with the usual backslash ('\').
10189 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010190 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010191 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
10192 used upper or lower case.
10193
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010194 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
10195
10196 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
10197 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10198 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
10199 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10200 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
10201 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
10202 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
10203 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
10204
10205 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
10206 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10207 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
10208 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10209 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
10210 expression.
10211
10212 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
10213 in the response buffer. A health check response will
10214 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
10215 this exact hexadecimal string.
10216 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
10217
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010218 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
10219 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
10220 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
10221 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
10222 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
10223 size of the original response. As such, the expected
10224 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
10225 size.
10226
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010227 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
10228 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
10229 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
10230 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
10231 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
10232 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
10233 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
10234 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
10235 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
10236 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
10237 the null character.
10238
10239 Examples :
10240 # perform a POP check
10241 option tcp-check
10242 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10243
10244 # perform an IMAP check
10245 option tcp-check
10246 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10247
10248 # look for the redis master server
10249 option tcp-check
10250 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010251 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010252 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10253 tcp-check expect string role:master
10254 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10255 tcp-check expect string +OK
10256
10257
10258 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
10259 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
10260
10261
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010262tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010263 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
10264 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010265 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010266
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010267 Arguments :
10268 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10269
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010270 <data> the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
10271 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010272
10273 Examples :
10274 # look for the redis master server
10275 option tcp-check
10276 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10277 tcp-check expect string role:master
10278
10279 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10280 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10281
10282
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010283tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010284 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010285 tcp health check
10286 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010287 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010288
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010289 Arguments :
10290 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010291
10292 <hexstring> test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
10293 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
10294 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact hexadecimal
10295 string. Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary
10296 protocols.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010297
10298 Examples :
10299 # redis check in binary
10300 option tcp-check
10301 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10302 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10303
10304
10305 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10306 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10307
10308
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010309tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010310 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010311 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010312 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010313
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010314 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010315 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10316 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10317 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10318 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10319 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10320 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10321 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10322 and '-'.
10323
10324 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
10325
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010326 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010327 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
10328
10329
10330tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010331 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010332 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010333 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010334
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010335 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010336 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10337 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10338 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10339 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10340 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10341 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10342 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10343 and '-'.
10344
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010345 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010346 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
10347
10348
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010349tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10350 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10352 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010353 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010354 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10355 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010356
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010357 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010358
10359 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
10360 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010361 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
10362 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
10363 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
10364 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
10365 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
10366 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010367
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010368 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10369 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10370 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
10371 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010372
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010373 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010374 - accept :
10375 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10376 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10377 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010378
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010379 - reject :
10380 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10381 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10382 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
10383 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
10384 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
10385 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
10386 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
10387 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
10388 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
10389 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
10390 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010391 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010392
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010393 - expect-proxy layer4 :
10394 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
10395 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
10396 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
10397 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
10398 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
10399 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
10400 hosts.
10401
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010402 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
10403 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
10404 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
10405 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
10406 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
10407 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
10408 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
10409 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
10410
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010411 - capture <sample> len <length> :
10412 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
10413 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
10414 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10415 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10416 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10417 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10418 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10419 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010420 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10421 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010422
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010423 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010424 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010425 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10426 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10427 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010428 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010429 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10430 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10431 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10432 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10433 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10434 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10435 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10436 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010437
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010438 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010439 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010440 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010441 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010442 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10443 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10444 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010445
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010446 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10447 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10448 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10449 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010450
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010451 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10452 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10453 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10454 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10455 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010456 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10457 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10458 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10459 layer7 information is extracted.
10460
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010461 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10462 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10463 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10464 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10465 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010466
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010467 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10468 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10469 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10470 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10471
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010472 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10473 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10474 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10475 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10476
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010477 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
10478 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10479 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10480 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10481 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010482
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010483 - set-src <expr> :
10484 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10485 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10486 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010487 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010488
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010489 Arguments:
10490 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10491 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010492
10493 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010494 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10495
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010496 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10497 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010498
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010499 - set-src-port <expr> :
10500 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10501 expression.
10502
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010503 Arguments:
10504 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10505 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010506
10507 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010508 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10509
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010510 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10511 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10512 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010513
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010514 - set-dst <expr> :
10515 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10516 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10517 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10518 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10519 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10520
10521 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10522 followed by some converters.
10523
10524 Example:
10525
10526 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10527 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10528
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010529 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10530 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10531
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010532 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10533 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10534 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10535 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10536
10537
10538 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10539 followed by some converters.
10540
10541 Example:
10542
10543 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10544
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010545 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10546 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10547 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10548
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010549 - "silent-drop" :
10550 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010551 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010552 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10553 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10554 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10555 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10556 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010557 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10558 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010559 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10560 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010561 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010562 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10563 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10564 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10565 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10566
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010567 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10568 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10569 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010570
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010571 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10572 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10573 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010574
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010575 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010576 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010577 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010578
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010579 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10580 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10581 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010582
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010583 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010584 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10585 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010586
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010587 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10588
10589 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10590
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010591 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10592
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010593 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010594
10595
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010596tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10597 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010599 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010600 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010601 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10602 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010603
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010604 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010605
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010606 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010607 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10608 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10609 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10610 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010611
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010612 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10613 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10614 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10615 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010616 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10617 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10618 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10619 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10620 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10621 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010622 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010623 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010624
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010625 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10626 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10627 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10628 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010629
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010630 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010631 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010632 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010633 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10634 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010635 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010636 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010637 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010638 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010639 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010640 - set-dst <expr>
10641 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010642 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010643 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010644 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010645 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010646 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010647
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010648 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10649 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010650 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10651 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010652
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010653 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10654 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10655 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10656 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10657 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10658 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010659
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010660 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010661 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10662 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010663
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010664 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010665 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10666 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10667 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10668 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010669 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10670 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10671 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010672
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010673 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010674 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10675 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10676 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010677
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010678 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10679 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10680
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010681 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010682 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10683 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010684
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010685 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10686 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010687 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010688 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10689 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010690 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010691 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010692 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010693 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10694 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010695 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010696 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10697 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010698
10699 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10700 followed by some converters.
10701
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010702 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10703 <var-name>.
10704
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010705 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10706 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10707 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10708 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10709 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10710
10711 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10712 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10713 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10714 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10715 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10716 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10717 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10718 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10719 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10720 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10721 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10722
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010723 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10724 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10725 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10726 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10727 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10728
10729 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10730
10731 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10732
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010733 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
10734 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
10735 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
10736 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
10737 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
10738 evaluated.
10739
10740 Example:
10741 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
10742
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010743 Example:
10744
10745 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010746 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010747
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010748 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010749 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10750 # and reject everything else.
10751 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10752 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010753 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010754 tcp-request content reject
10755
10756 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010757 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10758 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10759 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010760 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010761
10762 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10763 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10764 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010765 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010766 tcp-request content reject
10767
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010768 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010769 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010770 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010771 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010772 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10773 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010774
10775 Example:
10776 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10777 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010778 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010779
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010780 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010781 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010782
10783 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010784 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010785 # protecting all our sites
10786 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010787 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10788 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010789 ...
10790 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10791
10792 backend http_dynamic
10793 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010794 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010795 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010796 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010797 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010798 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010799 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010800
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010801 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010802
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010803 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10804 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010805
10806
10807tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10808 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010810 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010811 Arguments :
10812 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10813 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10814 as explained at the top of this document.
10815
10816 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10817 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10818 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10819 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10820 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10821
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010822 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10823 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10824 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10825 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10826
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010827 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10828 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010829 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010830 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010831 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10832 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10833 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10834 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010835
10836 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10837 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10838 it pass through unaffected.
10839
10840 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10841 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10842 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010843 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010844 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10845 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010846 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10847 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10848 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010849
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010850 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010851 "timeout client".
10852
10853
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010854tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10855 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10857 no | no | yes | yes
10858 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010859 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10860 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010861
10862 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10863
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010864 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010865 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10866 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010867 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10868 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010869
10870 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10871
10872 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10873 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10874 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10875 inserted.
10876
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010877 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010878 - accept :
10879 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10880 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10881 the rules evaluation.
10882
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010883 - close :
10884 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10885 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10886 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10887 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10888 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10889 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010890 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010891 protocols.
10892
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010893 - reject :
10894 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10895 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010896 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010897
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010898 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10899 Sets a variable.
10900
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010901 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10902 Unsets a variable.
10903
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010904 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10905 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10906 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10907 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10908
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010909 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10910 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10911 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10912 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10913
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010914 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
10915 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10916 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10917 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10918 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010919
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010920 - "silent-drop" :
10921 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010922 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010923 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10924 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10925 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10926 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10927 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010928 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10929 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010930 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10931 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010932 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010933 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10934 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10935 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10936 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10937
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010938 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10939 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10940
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010941 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10942 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10943 for changing the default action to a reject.
10944
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010945 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10946 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10947 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10948 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010949 period.
10950
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010951 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10952 declared inline.
10953
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010954 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10955 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010956 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010957 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10958 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010959 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010960 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010961 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010962 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10963 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010964 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010965 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10966 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010967
10968 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10969 followed by some converters.
10970
10971 Example:
10972
10973 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10974
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010975 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10976 <var-name>.
10977
10978 Example:
10979
10980 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10981
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010982 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10983 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10984 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10985 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10986 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10987
10988 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10989
10990 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10991
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010992 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10993
10994 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10995
10996
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010997tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10998 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11000 no | yes | yes | no
11001 Arguments :
11002 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11003 below.
11004
11005 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11006
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011007 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011008 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11009 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11010 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11011 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11012 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11013 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11014 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011015 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011016 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11017 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11018 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11019 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11020 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11021 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11022 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11023 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11024 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11025 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11026 instead.
11027
11028 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11029 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11030 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11031 rules which may be inserted.
11032
11033 Several types of actions are supported :
11034 - accept : the request is accepted
11035 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11036 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
11037 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011038 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011039 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011040 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011041 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011042 - silent-drop
11043
11044 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
11045 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
11046 sections for a complete description.
11047
11048 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11049 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11050 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
11051
11052 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
11053 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
11054 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
11055 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
11056 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
11057
11058 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11059 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11060
11061 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11062 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
11063 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
11064
11065 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11066 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
11067 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11068
11069 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
11070 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11071 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
11072
11073 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11074 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11075 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
11076
11077 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11078
11079 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
11080
11081
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011082tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
11083 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
11084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11085 no | no | yes | yes
11086 Arguments :
11087 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11088 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11089 as explained at the top of this document.
11090
11091 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
11092
11093
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011094timeout check <timeout>
11095 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
11096 established.
11097
11098 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11099 yes | no | yes | yes
11100 Arguments:
11101 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11102 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11103 as explained at the top of this document.
11104
11105 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
11106 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011107 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011108 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010011109 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
11110 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
11111 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011112
11113 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
11114 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
11115
11116 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
11117 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011118 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011119
11120 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11121 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11122 forget about it.
11123
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011124 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
11125 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011126
11127
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011128timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011129 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
11130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11131 yes | yes | yes | no
11132 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011133 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011134 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11135 as explained at the top of this document.
11136
11137 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11138 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11139 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010011140 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
11141 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
11142 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
11143 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011144 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
11145 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
11146 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011147 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011148 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011149 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
11150 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011151 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
11152 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011153
11154 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11155 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11156 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11157 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011158 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011159 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11160
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011161 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011162
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011163 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011164
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011165
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011166timeout client-fin <timeout>
11167 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
11168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11169 yes | yes | yes | no
11170 Arguments :
11171 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11172 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11173 as explained at the top of this document.
11174
11175 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11176 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11177 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11178 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11179 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
11180 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11181 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010011182 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
11183 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
11184 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011185
11186 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11187 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11188 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
11189
11190 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
11191
11192
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011193timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011194 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
11195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11196 yes | no | yes | yes
11197 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011198 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011199 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11200 as explained at the top of this document.
11201
11202 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011203 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011204 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011205 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011206 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
11207 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011208
11209 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11210 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11211 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11212 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011213 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011214 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11215
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011216 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011217
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011218
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011219timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
11220 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
11221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11222 yes | yes | yes | yes
11223 Arguments :
11224 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11225 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11226 as explained at the top of this document.
11227
11228 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
11229 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
11230 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
11231 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
11232 once the request has started to present itself.
11233
11234 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
11235 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
11236 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
11237 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
11238 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
11239
11240 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
11241 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
11242 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
11243 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
11244
11245 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
11246 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011247 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011248 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
11249 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011250 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011251
11252 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
11253 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
11254 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
11255 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
11256
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011257 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
11258 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011259 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
11260
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011261 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
11262
11263
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011264timeout http-request <timeout>
11265 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
11266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011267 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011268 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011269 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011270 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11271 as explained at the top of this document.
11272
11273 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
11274 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
11275 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
11276 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
11277 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
11278 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
11279 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020011280 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
11281 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
11282 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
11283 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011284 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011285 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
11286 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011287
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011288 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
11289 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
11290 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
11291 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
11292 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011293 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011294
11295 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
11296 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011297 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011298 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
11299 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
11300
11301 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011302 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
11303 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
11304 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011305
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011306 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011307 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011308
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011309
11310timeout queue <timeout>
11311 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
11312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11313 yes | no | yes | yes
11314 Arguments :
11315 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11316 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11317 as explained at the top of this document.
11318
11319 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
11320 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
11321 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
11322 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
11323 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
11324
11325 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
11326 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
11327 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
11328 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
11329
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011330 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011331
11332
11333timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011334 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
11335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11336 yes | no | yes | yes
11337 Arguments :
11338 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11339 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11340 as explained at the top of this document.
11341
11342 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11343 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11344 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
11345 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
11346 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
11347 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
11348 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
11349
11350 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11351 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11352 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
11353 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
11354 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011355 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011356 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011357 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
11358 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011359 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
11360 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011361
11362 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11363 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11364 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11365 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011366 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011367 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11368
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011369 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011370
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011371
11372timeout server-fin <timeout>
11373 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
11374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11375 yes | no | yes | yes
11376 Arguments :
11377 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11378 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11379 as explained at the top of this document.
11380
11381 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11382 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11383 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11384 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11385 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
11386 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11387 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
11388 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
11389 situations, it should not be needed.
11390
11391 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11392 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11393 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
11394
11395 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
11396
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011397
11398timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011399 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11401 yes | yes | yes | yes
11402 Arguments :
11403 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
11404 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11405 as explained at the top of this document.
11406
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020011407 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
11408 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
11409 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011410
11411 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11412 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11413 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
11414 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011415 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011416
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011417 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011418
11419
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011420timeout tunnel <timeout>
11421 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11423 yes | no | yes | yes
11424 Arguments :
11425 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11426 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11427 as explained at the top of this document.
11428
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011429 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011430 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11431 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11432 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011433 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11434 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011435 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11436 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11437 specified.
11438
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011439 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11440 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11441 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11442 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11443 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11444 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11445 state.
11446
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011447 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11448 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11449 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11450 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011451 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011452
11453 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11454 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11455 forget about it.
11456
11457 Example :
11458 defaults http
11459 option http-server-close
11460 timeout connect 5s
11461 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011462 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011463 timeout server 30s
11464 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11465
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011466 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011467
11468
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011469transparent (deprecated)
11470 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011472 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011473 Arguments : none
11474
11475 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11476 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11477 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11478 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11479 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11480 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11481 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11482 appropriate server.
11483
11484 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11485
11486 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11487 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11488
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011489 See also: "option transparent"
11490
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011491unique-id-format <string>
11492 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11494 yes | yes | yes | no
11495 Arguments :
11496 <string> is a log-format string.
11497
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011498 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11499 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11500 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11501 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011502
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011503 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11504 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11505 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11506 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11507 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11508 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11509 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11510 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011511
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011512 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11513 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011514
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011515 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011516
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011517 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011518
11519 will generate:
11520
11521 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11522
11523 See also: "unique-id-header"
11524
11525unique-id-header <name>
11526 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11528 yes | yes | yes | no
11529 Arguments :
11530 <name> is the name of the header.
11531
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011532 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11533 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011534
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011535 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011536
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011537 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011538 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11539
11540 will generate:
11541
11542 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11543
11544 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011545
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011546use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011547 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011548 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11549 no | yes | yes | no
11550 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011551 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11552 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011553
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011554 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11555 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011556
11557 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11558 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11559 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011560 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011561 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011562 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11563 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011564
11565 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11566 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11567 assign the backend.
11568
11569 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11570 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11571 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11572 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11573 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11574 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11575
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011576 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011577 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011578 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11579 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11580 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11581
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011582 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11583 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11584 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11585 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11586 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11587 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11588 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11589 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11590 cannot be forced from the request.
11591
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011592 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011593 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11594 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11595
11596 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11597 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011598
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011599use-fcgi-app <name>
11600 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
11601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11602 no | no | yes | yes
11603 Arguments :
11604 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
11605
11606 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011607
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011608use-server <server> if <condition>
11609use-server <server> unless <condition>
11610 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11612 no | no | yes | yes
11613 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011614 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
11615 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011616
11617 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11618
11619 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11620 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11621 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11622
11623 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11624 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11625 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11626 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11627 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11628 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11629 matches will assign the server.
11630
11631 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11632 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11633 with the next rules until one matches.
11634
11635 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11636 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11637 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11638 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11639
11640 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11641 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11642 stripped.
11643
11644 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11645 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11646 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11647 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11648
11649 Example :
11650 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11651 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11652 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11653 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11654 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11655 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011656 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011657 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11658 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11659
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011660 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
11661 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
11662 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
11663 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
11664 was conditionned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
11665 and we fall back to load balancing.
11666
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011667 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011668
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011669
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100116705. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011671--------------------------
11672
11673The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11674depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11675settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11676written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11677described in this section.
11678
11679
116805.1. Bind options
11681-----------------
11682
11683The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11684as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11685no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11686parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11687while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11688provided immediately after the setting name.
11689
11690The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11691
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011692accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11693 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11694 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11695 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11696 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11697 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11698 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11699 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11700 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11701 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011702 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11703 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11704 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011705
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011706accept-proxy
11707 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011708 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11709 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011710 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11711 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11712 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11713 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011714 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011715 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11716 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011717 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11718 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011719
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011720allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011721 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011722 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011723 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011724 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11725 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011726
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011727alpn <protocols>
11728 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11729 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11730 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011731 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011732 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011733 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11734 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11735 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11736 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11737 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11738 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11739 preference, like below :
11740
11741 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011742
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011743backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011744 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011745 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11746
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011747curves <curves>
11748 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11749 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11750 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11751 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11752 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11753 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11754
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011755ecdhe <named curve>
11756 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011757 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11758 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011759
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011760ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011761 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11762 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11763 client's certificate.
11764
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011765ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11766 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11767 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11768 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11769 error is ignored.
11770
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011771ca-sign-file <cafile>
11772 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11773 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11774 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11775 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11776 'generate-certificates' for details.
11777
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011778ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011779 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11780 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11781 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11782 'generate-certificates' for details.
11783
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011784ca-verify-file <cafile>
11785 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
11786 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
11787 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
11788 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
11789 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
11790
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011791ciphers <ciphers>
11792 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11793 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011794 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011795 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011796 information and recommendations see e.g.
11797 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11798 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11799 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11800
11801ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11802 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11803 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11804 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11805 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011806 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11807 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011808
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011809crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011810 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11811 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11812 to verify client's certificate.
11813
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011814crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011815 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11816 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11817 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11818 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11819 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010011820 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
11821 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011822
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010011823 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
11824 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
11825
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011826 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11827 are loaded.
11828
11829 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010011830 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
11831 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
11832 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
11833 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
11834 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
11835 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
11836 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011837 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011838
11839 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11840 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11841 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11842 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011843 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11844 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011845
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011846 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011847
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011848 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011849 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011850 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11851 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011852 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11853 clients).
11854
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011855 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11856 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11857 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11858 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11859 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11860 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11861 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11862 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11863 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11864 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11865 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11866 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11867 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11868
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011869 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11870 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11871 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11872 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11873 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11874
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011875 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11876 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11877 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11878 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011879
11880 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11881 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11882 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11883 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11884 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11885 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11886 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11887 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11888 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11889
11890 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11891
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011892 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011893 a cert bundle.
11894
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011895 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011896 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11897 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11898 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11899 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11900 provide multi-cert support.
11901
11902 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11903
11904 Filename | CN | SAN
11905 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11906 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011907 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011908 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11909 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11910
11911 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11912 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11913 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11914 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011915 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11916 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11917 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011918
11919 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11920 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11921
11922 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11923 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11924 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11925
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011926crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011927 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011928 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011929 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011930 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011931
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011932crt-list <file>
11933 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011934 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11935 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011936
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011937 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11938
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011939 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
11940 "no-ca-names", "crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With
11941 BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also
11942 supported. It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011943
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011944 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11945 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11946 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11947 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11948 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11949 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11950 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11951 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011952
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011953 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011954 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011955 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11956 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11957 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011958
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011959 crt-list file example:
11960 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011961 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011962 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011963 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011964
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011965defer-accept
11966 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11967 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11968 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011969 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011970 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11971 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11972 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11973 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11974 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11975 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11976 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11977
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011978expose-fd listeners
11979 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11980 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011981 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11982 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011983 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011984
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011985force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011986 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011987 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011988 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011989 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011990
11991force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011992 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011993 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011994 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011995
11996force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011997 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011998 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011999 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012000
12001force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012002 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012003 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012004 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012005
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012006force-tlsv13
12007 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12008 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012009 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012010
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012011generate-certificates
12012 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12013 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12014 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12015 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12016 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12017 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12018 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12019 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12020 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12021 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12022 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12023
12024 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12025 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012026 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012027 certificate is used many times.
12028
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012029gid <gid>
12030 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12031 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12032 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12033 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12034 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12035
12036group <group>
12037 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12038 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12039 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12040 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12041 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12042
12043id <id>
12044 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12045 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12046 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12047 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12048
12049interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012050 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12051 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12052 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12053 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12054 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12055 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012056 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12057 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12058 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12059 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12060 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12061 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012062
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012063level <level>
12064 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12065 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12066 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012067 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012068 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12069 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12070 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012071 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012072 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012073 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012074 all counters).
12075
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020012076severity-output <format>
12077 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
12078 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
12079 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
12080 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
12081 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
12082 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
12083 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
12084 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
12085 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
12086 rfc5424 convention.
12087
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012088maxconn <maxconn>
12089 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
12090 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
12091 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
12092 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
12093 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
12094 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
12095 eat all memory.
12096
12097mode <mode>
12098 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
12099 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
12100 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
12101 UNIX sockets.
12102
12103mss <maxseg>
12104 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
12105 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
12106 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
12107 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
12108 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
12109 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
12110 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
12111 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
12112 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
12113 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
12114 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
12115
12116name <name>
12117 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
12118 page.
12119
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012120namespace <name>
12121 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12122 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
12123 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12124 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12125
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012126nice <nice>
12127 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
12128 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
12129 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
12130 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
12131 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
12132 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
12133 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
12134 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
12135 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
12136 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
12137 one for an RDP socket.
12138
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012139no-ca-names
12140 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12141 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012142 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012143
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012144no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012145 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012146 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012147 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012148 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012149 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
12150 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012151
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012152no-tls-tickets
12153 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12154 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12155 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012156 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
12157 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012158 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12159 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12160 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012161
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012162no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012163 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012164 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012165 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012166 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012167 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12168 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012169
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012170no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012171 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012172 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012173 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012174 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012175 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12176 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012177
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012178no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012179 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012180 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012181 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012182 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012183 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12184 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012185
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012186no-tlsv13
12187 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12188 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
12189 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
12190 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012191 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12192 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012193
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012194npn <protocols>
12195 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12196 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12197 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012198 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012199 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012200 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12201 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
12202 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
12203 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
12204 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012205
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012206prefer-client-ciphers
12207 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
12208 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
12209 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020012210 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
12211 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
12212 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012213
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012214process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012215 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012216 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012217 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012218 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
12219 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
12220 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
12221 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012222 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012223 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
12224 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
12225 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
12226 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
12227 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012228
12229 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
12230
12231 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
12232 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
12233 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
12234 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
12235 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
12236 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
12237 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
12238 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020012239
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012240proto <name>
12241 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
12242 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
12243 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
12244 in haproxy -vv.
12245 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12246 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080012247 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012248 h2" on the bind line.
12249
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012250ssl
12251 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012252 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012253 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
12254 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020012255 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
12256 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012257
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012258ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12259 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
12260 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
12261 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12262
12263ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12264 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
12265 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
12266 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12267
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010012268strict-sni
12269 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
12270 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
12271 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
12272 See the "crt" option for more information.
12273
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012274tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012275 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012276 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
12277 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012278 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012279 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
12280 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
12281 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
12282 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
12283 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
12284 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
12285 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12286
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012287tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010012288 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012289 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
12290 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
12291 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
12292 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
12293 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
12294 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
12295 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020012296 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
12297 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
12298 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012299
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012300tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
12301 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010012302 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
12303 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
12304 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
12305 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
12306 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
12307 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
12308 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
12309 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
12310 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
12311 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012312 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
12313 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
12314
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012315transparent
12316 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12317 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
12318 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
12319 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
12320 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
12321 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
12322 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
12323 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
12324 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
12325 so check for support with your vendor.
12326
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012327v4v6
12328 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12329 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
12330 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12331 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012332 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012333
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012334v6only
12335 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12336 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
12337 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012338 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
12339 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012340
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012341uid <uid>
12342 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
12343 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12344 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
12345 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
12346 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12347
12348user <user>
12349 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
12350 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12351 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
12352 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
12353 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12354
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012355verify [none|optional|required]
12356 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
12357 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
12358 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
12359 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
12360 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012361 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
12362 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
12363 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
12364 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012365
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200123665.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012367------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012368
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012369The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
12370which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
12371arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
12372settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
12373after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
12374Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
12375address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012377 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012378 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012379
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012380Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
12381keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
12382
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012383The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012384
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012385addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012386 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010012387 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
12388 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
12389 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
12390 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
12391 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012392
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012393agent-check
12394 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012395 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010012396 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
12397 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
12398 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012399
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012400 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012401 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020012402 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
12403 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
12404 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012405
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012406 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
12407 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
12408 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
12409 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
12410 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020012411
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012412 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012413 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012414
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012415 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12416 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
12417 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012418
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012419 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12420 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12421 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012422
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012423 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
12424 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12425 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12426 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12427 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012428 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012429 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012430
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012431 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12432 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012433
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012434 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12435 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12436 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12437 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12438 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12439 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12440 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12441 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12442 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012443
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012444 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12445 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012446 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12447 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12448 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012449 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012450
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012451 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012452 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012453
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012454agent-send <string>
12455 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12456 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12457 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12458 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12459 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12460
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012461agent-inter <delay>
12462 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12463 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12464
12465 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12466 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12467 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12468 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12469 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12470 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12471 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12472 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12473 of backends use the same servers.
12474
12475 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12476
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012477agent-addr <addr>
12478 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12479
12480 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12481 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12482 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12483 hostname, it will be resolved.
12484
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012485agent-port <port>
12486 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12487
12488 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12489
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012490allow-0rtt
12491 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012492 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12493 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012494
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012495alpn <protocols>
12496 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12497 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12498 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012499 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012500 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12501 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12502 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12503 now obsolete NPN extension.
12504 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12505 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12506
12507 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12508
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012509backup
12510 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12511 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12512 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12513 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012514 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12515 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012516
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012517ca-file <cafile>
12518 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12519 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12520 server's certificate.
12521
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012522check
12523 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010012524 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
12525 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
12526 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
12527 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
12528 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
12529 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
12530 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090012531 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
12532 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012533 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
12534 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012535
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012536check-send-proxy
12537 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12538 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12539 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12540 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12541 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12542 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12543 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12544
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012545check-alpn <protocols>
12546 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12547 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12548 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12549
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012550check-proto <name>
12551 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
12552 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
12553 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
12554 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
12555 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12556 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
12557 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
12558
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012559check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012560 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012561 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12562 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012563
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012564check-ssl
12565 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12566 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12567 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12568 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012569 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012570 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12571 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012572 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012573 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12574 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012575
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012576check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012577 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012578 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12579 for normal traffic.
12580
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012581ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012582 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12583 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12584 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012585 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12586 information and recommendations see e.g.
12587 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12588 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12589 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012590
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012591ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12592 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12593 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12594 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12595 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012596 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12597 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12598 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012599
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012600cookie <value>
12601 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12602 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12603 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12604 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12605 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12606 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12607 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12608
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012609crl-file <crlfile>
12610 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12611 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12612 to verify server's certificate.
12613
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012614crt <cert>
12615 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12616 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12617 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12618 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12619 certificate request.
12620
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012621disabled
12622 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12623 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12624 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12625 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12626 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012627 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012628
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012629enabled
12630 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12631 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12632 default value.
12633 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12634 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012635
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012636error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012637 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12638 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12639 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012640
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012641 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012642
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012643fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012644 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12645 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12646 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12647
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012648force-sslv3
12649 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12650 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012651 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012652 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012653
12654force-tlsv10
12655 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012656 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012657 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012658
12659force-tlsv11
12660 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012661 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012662 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012663
12664force-tlsv12
12665 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012666 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012667 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012668
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012669force-tlsv13
12670 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12671 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012672 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012673
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012674id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012675 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12676 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12677 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012678
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012679init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12680 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12681 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012682 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012683 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12684 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12685 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12686 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12687 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12688 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12689 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12690 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12691 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012692 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012693 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12694 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12695 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12696 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12697 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12698 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012699 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012700
12701 Example:
12702 defaults
12703 # never fail on address resolution
12704 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12705
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012706inter <delay>
12707fastinter <delay>
12708downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012709 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12710 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12711 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12712 between checks depending on the server state :
12713
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012714 Server state | Interval used
12715 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12716 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12717 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12718 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12719 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12720 or yet unchecked. |
12721 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12722 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12723 | "inter" otherwise.
12724 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012725
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012726 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12727 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12728 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12729 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012730 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12731 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12732 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12733 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12734 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012735
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012736maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012737 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12738 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012739 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
12740 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012741 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12742 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12743 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12744 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12745
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012746 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
12747 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
12748 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
12749 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
12750 than 50 concurrent requests.
12751
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012752maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012753 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12754 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12755 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12756 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12757 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12758 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12759 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12760
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012761max-reuse <count>
12762 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12763 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12764 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12765 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12766 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12767 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12768 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12769 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12770
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012771minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012772 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12773 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12774 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12775 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12776 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12777 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012778 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012779 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012780
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012781namespace <name>
12782 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12783 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12784 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12785 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12786
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012787no-agent-check
12788 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12789 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12790 default value.
12791 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12792 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12793
12794no-backup
12795 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12796 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12797 default value.
12798 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12799 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12800
12801no-check
12802 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12803 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12804 default value.
12805 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12806 "default-server" "check" setting.
12807
12808no-check-ssl
12809 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12810 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12811 default value.
12812 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12813 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12814
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012815no-send-proxy
12816 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12817 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12818 default value.
12819 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12820 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12821
12822no-send-proxy-v2
12823 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12824 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12825 default value.
12826 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12827 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12828
12829no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12830 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12831 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12832 default value.
12833 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12834 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12835
12836no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12837 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12838 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12839 default value.
12840 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12841 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12842
12843no-ssl
12844 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12845 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12846 default value.
12847 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12848 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12849
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012850no-ssl-reuse
12851 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12852 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12853 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12854 and for paranoid users.
12855
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012856no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012857 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12858 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012859 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012860
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012861 Supported in default-server: No
12862
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012863no-tls-tickets
12864 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12865 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12866 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012867 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12868 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012869 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12870 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12871 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012872 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012873
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012874no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012875 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012876 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12877 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012878 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12879 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012880 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012881
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012882 Supported in default-server: No
12883
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012884no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012885 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012886 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12887 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012888 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12889 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012890 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012891
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012892 Supported in default-server: No
12893
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012894no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012895 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012896 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12897 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012898 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12899 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012900 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012901
12902 Supported in default-server: No
12903
12904no-tlsv13
12905 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12906 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12907 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12908 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12909 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012910 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012911
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012912 Supported in default-server: No
12913
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012914no-verifyhost
12915 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12916 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12917 default value.
12918 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12919 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012920
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012921no-tfo
12922 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12923 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12924 default value.
12925 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12926 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12927
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012928non-stick
12929 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12930 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12931 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12932
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012933npn <protocols>
12934 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12935 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12936 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012937 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012938 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12939 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12940 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12941
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012942observe <mode>
12943 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12944 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12945 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12946 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12947 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12948 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012949 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012950
12951 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12952
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012953on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012954 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12955 Currently, four modes are available:
12956 - fastinter: force fastinter
12957 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12958 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12959 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12960 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12961
12962 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12963
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012964on-marked-down <action>
12965 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12966 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012967 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12968 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12969 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12970 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12971 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12972 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12973 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12974 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012975
12976 Actions are disabled by default
12977
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012978on-marked-up <action>
12979 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12980 Currently one action is available:
12981 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12982 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12983 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12984 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012985 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12986 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012987 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12988 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12989
12990 Actions are disabled by default
12991
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012992pool-max-conn <max>
12993 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12994 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12995 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12996 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12997 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12998 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12999
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013000pool-purge-delay <delay>
13001 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010013002 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020013003 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013004
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013005port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013006 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
13007 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
13008 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
13009 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
13010 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
13011 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
13012
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013013proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013014 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
13015 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
13016 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
13017 reported in haproxy -vv.
13018 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
13019 protocol for all connections established to this server.
13020
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013021redir <prefix>
13022 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
13023 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
13024 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
13025 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
13026 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
13027 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
13028 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
13029 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013030 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013031 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013032 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
13033 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
13034 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
13035 loop between the client and HAProxy!
13036
13037 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
13038
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013039rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013040 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
13041 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
13042 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
13043
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013044resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
13045 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
13046 server.
13047
13048 Available options:
13049
13050 * allow-dup-ip
13051 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
13052 resolution at runtime is in operation.
13053 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
13054 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
13055 For such case, simply enable this option.
13056 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
13057
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050013058 * ignore-weight
13059 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
13060 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
13061 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
13062
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013063 * prevent-dup-ip
13064 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
13065 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
13066 same fqdn.
13067 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
13068
13069 Example:
13070 backend b_myapp
13071 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
13072 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13073 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13074
13075 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
13076 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
13077 it
13078 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
13079 different address
13080
13081 Default value: not set
13082
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013083resolve-prefer <family>
13084 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
13085 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
13086 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
13087 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
13088
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020013089 Default value: ipv6
13090
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013091 Example:
13092
13093 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013094
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013095resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013096 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013097 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013098 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013099 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
13100 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013101 configured network, another address is selected.
13102
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013103 Example:
13104
13105 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013106
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013107resolvers <id>
13108 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
13109 hostname.
13110
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013111 Example:
13112
13113 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013114
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013115 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013116
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013117send-proxy
13118 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
13119 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
13120 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
13121 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013122 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
13123 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
13124 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
13125 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
13126 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
13127 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
13128 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
13129 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
13130 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
13131 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013132 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
13133 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013134
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013135send-proxy-v2
13136 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
13137 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13138 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13139 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020013140 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
13141 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
13142 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
13143 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013144
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013145proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010013146 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
13147 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
13148
13149 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
13150 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
13151 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
13152 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
13153 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
13154 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
13155 connection is supported).
13156 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
13157 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
13158 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
13159 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
13160 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
13161 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
13162 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013163
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013164send-proxy-v2-ssl
13165 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13166 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13167 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13168 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13169 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13170 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
13171 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013172 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
13173 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013174
13175send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13176 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13177 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13178 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13179 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13180 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13181 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
13182 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
13183 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013184 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
13185 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013186
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013187slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013188 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
13189 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
13190 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
13191 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
13192 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
13193 parameters :
13194
13195 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
13196 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
13197
13198 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
13199 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
13200 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
13201 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
13202
13203 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
13204 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
13205 seen as failed.
13206
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013207sni <expression>
13208 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
13209 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
13210 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
13211 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020013212 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
13213 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013214 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010013215 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
13216 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013217
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013218source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020013219source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013220source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013221 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
13222 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
13223 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
13224 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
13225
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013226 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
13227 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
13228 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
13229 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
13230 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
13231 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
13232 server.
13233
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000013234 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
13235 specifying the source address without port(s).
13236
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013237ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020013238 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
13239 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
13240 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
13241 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
13242 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
13243 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013244 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
13245 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013246
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013247ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13248 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
13249 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13250 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13251
13252ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13253 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
13254 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13255 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
13256
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013257ssl-reuse
13258 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
13259 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13260 default value.
13261 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13262 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
13263
13264stick
13265 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
13266 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13267 default value.
13268 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13269 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013270
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013271socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013272 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013273 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
13274 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
13275
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013276tcp-ut <delay>
13277 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
13278 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
13279 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013280 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013281 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
13282 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
13283 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
13284 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
13285 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
13286 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
13287 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
13288 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
13289 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13290
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013291tfo
13292 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
13293 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
13294 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
13295 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
13296 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013297 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013298
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013299track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020013300 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
13301 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
13302 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
13303 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013304 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
13305
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013306tls-tickets
13307 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
13308 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13309 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013310 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13311 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13312 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013313 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010013314 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013315
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013316verify [none|required]
13317 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010013318 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013319 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
13320 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013321 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013322 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
13323 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
13324 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
13325 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
13326 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
13327 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
13328 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
13329 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013330
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013331verifyhost <hostname>
13332 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013333 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
13334 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
13335 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
13336 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
13337 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
13338 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
13339 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
13340 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013341
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013342weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013343 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
13344 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
13345 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020013346 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
13347 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
13348 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
13349 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
13350 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
13351 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013352
13353
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200133545.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
13355-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013356
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013357HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
13358using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
13359configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013360This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
13361can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
13362workload.
13363This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
13364resolution at run time.
13365Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
13366carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
13367
13368
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200133695.3.1. Global overview
13370----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013371
13372As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
13373different steps of the process life:
13374
13375 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
13376 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
13377 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
13378
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013379 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
13380 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013381
13382A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
13383 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
13384 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
13385 resolution to know this new IP.
13386
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013387When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013388HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013389SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
13390from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
13391will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
13392will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020013393
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013394A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013395 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013396 first valid response.
13397
13398 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
13399 servers return an error.
13400
13401
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200134025.3.2. The resolvers section
13403----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013404
13405This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013406HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
13407contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013408
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013409When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
13410uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
13411is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
13412answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
13413
13414When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013415used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013416
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013417 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
13418 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
13419 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013420
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013421 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
13422 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013423
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013424 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
13425 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
13426 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013427
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013428For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
13429following scenarios are possible:
13430
13431 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
13432 ignored
13433
13434 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
13435 applied
13436
13437 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
13438 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
13439
13440 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
13441 retries the query with a new type
13442
13443 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
13444 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013445
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013446As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
13447a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013448<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013449
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013450
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013451resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013452 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013453
13454A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13455
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013456accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013457 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013458 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013459 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13460 by RFC 6891)
13461
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013462 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13463
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013464nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13465 DNS server description:
13466 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13467 <ip> : IP address of the server
13468 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13469
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013470parse-resolv-conf
13471 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13472 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13473 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13474
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013475hold <status> <period>
13476 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13477 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013478 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013479 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013480 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13481 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13482 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13483
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013484 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013485
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013486resolve_retries <nb>
13487 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13488 giving up.
13489 Default value: 3
13490
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013491 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13492 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13493 type.
13494
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013495timeout <event> <time>
13496 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13497 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13498 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013499 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13500 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013501 Default value: 1s
13502 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013503 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013504 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013505 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13506 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13507
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013508 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013509
13510 resolvers mydns
13511 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13512 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013513 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013514 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013515 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013516 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013517 hold other 30s
13518 hold refused 30s
13519 hold nx 30s
13520 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013521 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013522 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013523
13524
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200135256. Cache
13526---------
13527
13528HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
13529(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
13530RAM.
13531
13532The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
13533this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
13534
13535If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
13536independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
13537when we try to allocate a new one.
13538
13539The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
13540
13541It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
13542"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
13543for more details.
13544
13545When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
13546replaced by "<CACHE>".
13547
13548
135496.1. Limitation
13550----------------
13551
13552The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
13553
13554- If the response is not a 200
13555- If the response contains a Vary header
13556- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
13557- If the response is not cacheable
13558
13559- If the request is not a GET
13560- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
13561- If the request contains an Authorization header
13562
13563
135646.2. Setup
13565-----------
13566
13567To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
13568the corresponding http-request and response actions.
13569
13570
135716.2.1. Cache section
13572---------------------
13573
13574cache <name>
13575 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
13576 size of cache is mandatory.
13577
13578total-max-size <megabytes>
13579 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
13580 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
13581
13582max-object-size <bytes>
13583 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
13584 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
13585 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
13586
13587max-age <seconds>
13588 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
13589 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
13590 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
13591 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
13592 default.
13593
13594
135956.2.2. Proxy section
13596---------------------
13597
13598http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13599 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
13600 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
13601 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
13602 after this one.
13603
13604http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13605 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
13606 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
13607 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
13608 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
13609
13610
13611Example:
13612
13613 backend bck1
13614 mode http
13615
13616 http-request cache-use foobar
13617 http-response cache-store foobar
13618 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
13619
13620 cache foobar
13621 total-max-size 4
13622 max-age 240
13623
13624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136257. Using ACLs and fetching samples
13626----------------------------------
13627
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013628HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013629client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
13630The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
13631these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
13632but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
13633data called patterns.
13634
13635
136367.1. ACL basics
13637---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013638
13639The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
13640content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
13641from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
13642simple :
13643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013644 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013645 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013646 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
13647 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013649The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
13650adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013651
13652In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
13653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013654 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013655
13656This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
13657Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
13658and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013659an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
13660conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
13661as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
13662are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013663
13664ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
13665'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
13666which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
13667
13668There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
13669performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013671The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13672specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13673this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013674methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13675ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013676
13677Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13678 - boolean
13679 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13680 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13681 - string
13682 - data block
13683
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013684Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13685converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13686would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13687The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13688which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13689
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013690Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13691keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13692fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13693which are summarized in the table below :
13694
13695 +---------------------+-----------------+
13696 | Sample or converter | Default |
13697 | output type | matching method |
13698 +---------------------+-----------------+
13699 | boolean | bool |
13700 +---------------------+-----------------+
13701 | integer | int |
13702 +---------------------+-----------------+
13703 | ip | ip |
13704 +---------------------+-----------------+
13705 | string | str |
13706 +---------------------+-----------------+
13707 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13708 +---------------------+-----------------+
13709
13710Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13711matching method, see below.
13712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013713The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13714 - boolean
13715 - integer or integer range
13716 - IP address / network
13717 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13718 - regular expression
13719 - hex block
13720
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013721The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13722
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013723 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13724 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013725 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013726 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013727 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013728 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013729 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013731The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13732read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13733if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13734lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13735will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13736beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13737a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13738lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13739exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13740
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013741The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13742parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13743ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13744a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13745check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13746
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013747The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13748socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13749file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013751Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13752loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13753
13754 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13755
13756In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13757the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13758case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13759as well.
13760
13761The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13762sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13763do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13764methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13765is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013766obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013767followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13768default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13769that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13770string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13771
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013772The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13773By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13774string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13775resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13776server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013777waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013778flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13779function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013781There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13782sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13783be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013784
13785 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13786 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013787 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13788 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13789 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13790 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013791
13792 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13793 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013794 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013795
13796 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013797 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013798
13799 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013800 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013801
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013802 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013803 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13804
13805 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13806 binary or string samples.
13807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013808 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13809 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013811 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13812 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13813 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013815 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13816 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013818 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13819 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013821 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13822 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013824 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13825 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013826 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013828 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13829 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13830 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013831
13832For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13833request, it is possible to do :
13834
13835 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13836
13837In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13838buffer, one would use the following acl :
13839
13840 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13841
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013842On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13843possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13844
13845 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013847All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13848criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13849method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13850to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13851criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13852the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013854If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013855the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13856For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013858 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13859 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13860 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13861 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013862
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013863
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013864The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13865types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13866combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13867brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13868default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013870 +-------------------------------------------------+
13871 | Input sample type |
13872 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013873 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013874 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13875 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13876 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013877 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013878 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013879 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013880 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013881 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013882 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013883 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013884 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013885 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013886 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013887 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013888 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013889 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013890 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013891 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013892 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013893 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013894 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013895 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013896 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013897 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013898 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13899 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13900 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013901
13902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200139037.1.1. Matching booleans
13904------------------------
13905
13906In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13907Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13908When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13909that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13910
13911Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13912return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13913"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13914
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200139167.1.2. Matching integers
13917------------------------
13918
13919Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13920enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13921to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13922
13923Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13924matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13925lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013926
13927For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13928unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13929representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13930
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013931As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13932two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13933instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13934ranges and operators.
13935
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013936For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013937operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13938Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13939of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013940
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013941Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013942
13943 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13944 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13945 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13946 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13947 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13948
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013949For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013950
13951 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13952
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013953This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13954
13955 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13956
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200139587.1.3. Matching strings
13959-----------------------
13960
13961String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13962different forms :
13963
13964 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013965 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013966
13967 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013968 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013969
13970 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13971 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13972
13973 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13974 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13975
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013976 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013977 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13978 matches.
13979
13980 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13981 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13982 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013983
13984String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13985exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13986characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13987string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13988to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013989before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013990
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010013991Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
13992(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
13993Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
13994
13995Example:
13996 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
13997 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
13998
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200140007.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
14001---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014002
14003Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
14004they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
14005possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
14006passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
14007the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014008the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
14009match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014010
14011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200140127.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
14013-------------------------------------
14014
14015It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
14016not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
14017a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
14018to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
14019digits may be used upper or lower case.
14020
14021Example :
14022 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
14023 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
14024
14025
140267.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
14027---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014028
14029IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
14030netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
14031within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014032host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014033difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
14034at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
14035does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
14036parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014037
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020014038The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
14039abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
14040
14041 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14042 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
14043 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14044 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
14045 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
14046 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
14047 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
14048 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14049
14050Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
14051192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
14052
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014053IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
14054Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
14055trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
14056IPv6 patterns.
14057
14058HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
14059following situations :
14060 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
14061 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
14062 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
14063 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
14064 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
14065 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
14066 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
14067 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
14068 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
14069 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
14070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014071
140727.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
14073----------------------------------
14074
14075Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
14076combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
14077
14078 - AND (implicit)
14079 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
14080 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014082A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014084 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014086Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
14087indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014089For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
14090"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
14091requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
14092is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
14093
14094 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014095 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
14096 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
14097 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014098
14099To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
14100and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
14101
14102 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
14103 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
14104 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
14105 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
14106
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014107 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014108 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
14109 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
14110 use_backend www if host_www
14111
14112It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
14113expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
14114be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
14115the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
14116
14117 The following rule :
14118
14119 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014120 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014121
14122 Can also be written that way :
14123
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014124 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014125
14126It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
14127to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
14128simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
14129sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
14130good use is the following :
14131
14132 With named ACLs :
14133
14134 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
14135 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
14136 monitor fail if site_dead
14137
14138 With anonymous ACLs :
14139
14140 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
14141
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014142See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
14143keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014144
14145
141467.3. Fetching samples
14147---------------------
14148
14149Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
14150against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
14151sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
14152ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
14153of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
14154available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
14155
14156This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
14157Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
14158compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
14159deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
14160
14161The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
14162matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
14163method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
14164indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
14165
14166As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
14167when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
14168mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
14169the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
14170ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
14171
14172Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
14173multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
14174when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014175incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
14176are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014177is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
14178all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
14179
14180Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
14181 - name
14182 - name(arg1)
14183 - name(arg1,arg2)
14184
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014185
141867.3.1. Converters
14187-----------------
14188
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014189Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
14190of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
14191is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
14192was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014193has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014194unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
14195
14196These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
14197sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
14198the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014199support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014200
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014201A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
14202support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
14203supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
14204(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
14205bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
14206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014207The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014208
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001420951d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
14210 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14211 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14212 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
14213 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14214 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14215
14216 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014217 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
14218 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000014219 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
14220 frontend http-in
14221 bind *:8081
14222 default_backend servers
14223 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14224 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14225
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014226add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014227 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014228 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014229 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
14230 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014231 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014232 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14233 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14234 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14235 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014236 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014237 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014238
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010014239aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
14240 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
14241 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
14242 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
14243 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
14244 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
14245 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
14246
14247 Example:
14248 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
14249 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
14250
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014251and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014252 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014253 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014254 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14255 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014256 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014257 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14258 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14259 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14260 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014261 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014262 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014263
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020014264b64dec
14265 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
14266 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
14267
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014268base64
14269 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014270 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014271 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
14272
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014273bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014274 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014275 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014276 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014277 presence of a flag).
14278
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014279bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
14280 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
14281 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014282 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014283
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014284concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
14285 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
14286 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
14287 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
14288 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
14289 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
14290 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
14291 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
14292 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
14293 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
14294 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014295 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
14296 parethesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
14297 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
14298 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014299
14300 Example:
14301 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
14302 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
14303 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014304 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014305 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
14306
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014307cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014308 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
14309 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014310
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014311crc32([<avalanche>])
14312 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
14313 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14314 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14315 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14316 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14317 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
14318 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
14319 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
14320 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
14321 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014322 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
14323
14324crc32c([<avalanche>])
14325 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
14326 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14327 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14328 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
14329 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
14330 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
14331 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
14332 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014333
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020014334cut_crlf
14335 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
14336 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
14337 updated.
14338
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010014339da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014340 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
14341 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
14342 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
14343 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014344 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014345 configuration language.
14346
14347 Example:
14348 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014349 bind *:8881
14350 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014351 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014352
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010014353debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
14354 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
14355 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
14356 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
14357 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
14358 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
14359 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
14360 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
14361 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
14362 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
14363 printable sample types.
14364
14365 Example:
14366 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020014367
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014368div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014369 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14370 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014371 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014372 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
14373 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014374 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014375 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14376 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14377 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14378 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014379 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014380 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014381
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014382djb2([<avalanche>])
14383 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
14384 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14385 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14386 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14387 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14388 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14389 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014390 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
14391 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014392
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014393even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014394 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014395 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
14396
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014397field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14398 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
14399 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
14400 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
14401 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
14402 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
14403 fields.
14404
14405 Example :
14406 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
14407 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14408 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
14409 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
14410 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010014411
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014412hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014413 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014414 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014415 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014416 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010014417
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014418hex2i
14419 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014420 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014421
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020014422htonl
14423 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
14424 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
14425 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
14426 unsigned 32-bit integer.
14427
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014428http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014429 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14430 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014431 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
14432 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
14433 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
14434 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
14435 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
14436 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
14437 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
14438 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014439
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014440in_table(<table>)
14441 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14442 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
14443 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014444 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014445 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
14446
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014447ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
14448 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014449 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014450 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
14451 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
14452 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
14453 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
14454 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014455
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014456json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014457 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014458 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014459 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014460 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
14461 of errors:
14462 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
14463 bytes, ...)
14464 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
14465 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
14466
14467 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
14468 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
14469 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14470 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14471 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14472 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014473 - "ascii" : never fails;
14474 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14475 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014476 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014477 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014478 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14479 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14480
14481 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014482 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014483
14484 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014485 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014486 capture request header user-agent len 150
14487 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014488
14489 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14490 GET / HTTP/1.0
14491 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14492
14493 Output log:
14494 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14495
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014496language(<value>[,<default>])
14497 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14498 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14499 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14500 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14501 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14502 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14503 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14504 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14505 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014506 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014507 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14508 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014509
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014510 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014511
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014512 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
14513 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014514
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014515 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
14516 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
14517 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
14518 use_backend spanish if es
14519 use_backend french if fr
14520 use_backend english if en
14521 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014522
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010014523length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010014524 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
14525 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14526 type. The result is of type integer.
14527
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014528lower
14529 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
14530 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14531 type. The result is of type string.
14532
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014533ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14534 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14535 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14536 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14537 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14538 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14539 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14540
14541 Example :
14542
14543 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014544 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014545 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14546
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020014547ltrim(<chars>)
14548 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
14549 representation of the input sample.
14550
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014551map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14552map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14553map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14554 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
14555 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
14556 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
14557 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
14558 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
14559 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
14560 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
14561 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014562
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014563 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
14564 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
14565 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014566
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014567 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014568 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014569
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014570 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
14571 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14572 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
14573 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020014574 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
14575 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014576 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
14577 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14578 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
14579 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14580 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
14581 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14582 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
14583 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080014584 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
14585 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14586 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014587 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14588 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
14589 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14590 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
14591 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014592
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010014593 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
14594 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
14595 the corresponding match text.
14596
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014597 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
14598 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
14599 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
14600 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
14601 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014602
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014603 Example :
14604
14605 # this is a comment and is ignored
14606 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
14607 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
14608 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
14609 | | | `---------- value
14610 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
14611 | `---------------------------- key
14612 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
14613
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014614mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014615 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14616 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014617 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014618 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014619 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014620 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14621 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14622 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14623 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014624 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014625 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014626
14627mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014628 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020014629 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
14630 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014631 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014632 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014633 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014634 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14635 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14636 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14637 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014638 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014639 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014640
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010014641nbsrv
14642 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
14643 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
14644 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
14645 map lookup.
14646
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014647neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014648 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
14649 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
14650 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
14651 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014652
14653not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014654 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014655 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014656 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014657 absence of a flag).
14658
14659odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014660 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014661 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
14662
14663or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014664 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014665 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014666 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14667 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014668 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014669 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14670 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14671 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14672 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014673 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014674 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014675
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014676protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
14677 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
14678 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
14679 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
14680 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
14681 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14682 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14683 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14684 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
14685 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
14686 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14687 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14688
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010014689regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014690 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
14691 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
14692 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
14693 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
14694 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
14695 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
14696 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
14697 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
14698 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014699 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
14700 of characters with other ones.
14701
14702 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
14703 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
14704 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
14705 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
14706 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
14707 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014708
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010014709 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014710
14711 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14712 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14713 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014714 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014715
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010014716 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
14717 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
14718
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010014719 # capture groups and backreferences
14720 # both lines do the same.
14721 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)]'
14722 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
14723
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014724capture-req(<id>)
14725 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14726 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14727
14728 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014729 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14730 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014731
14732capture-res(<id>)
14733 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14734 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14735
14736 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014737 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14738 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014739
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020014740rtrim(<chars>)
14741 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
14742 of the input sample.
14743
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014744sdbm([<avalanche>])
14745 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14746 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14747 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14748 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14749 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14750 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14751 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014752 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14753 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014754
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014755set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014756 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14757 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14758 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014759 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014760 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14761 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014762 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014763 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14764 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014765 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014766 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014767
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014768sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014769 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014770 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14771
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014772sha2([<bits>])
14773 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
14774 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
14775
14776 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
14777 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
14778
14779 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14780 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14781
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020014782srv_queue
14783 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
14784 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
14785 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
14786 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
14787 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
14788
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014789strcmp(<var>)
14790 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14791 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14792 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14793 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14794 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14795 shorter).
14796
14797 Example :
14798
14799 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14800 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14801 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14802
14803
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014804sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014805 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14806 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014807 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014808 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14809 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014810 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014811 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14812 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014813 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014814 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14815 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014816 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014817 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014818
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014819table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14820 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14821 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14822 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14823 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14824 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14825 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14826
14827
14828table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14829 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14830 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14831 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14832 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14833 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14834 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14835
14836table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14837 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14838 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014839 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014840 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14841 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14842
14843table_conn_cur(<table>)
14844 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14845 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14846 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14847 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14848 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14849
14850table_conn_rate(<table>)
14851 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14852 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14853 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14854 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14855 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14856
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014857table_gpt0(<table>)
14858 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14859 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14860 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14861 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14862 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14863
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014864table_gpc0(<table>)
14865 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14866 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14867 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14868 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14869 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14870
14871table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14872 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14873 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14874 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14875 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14876 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14877 sample fetch keyword.
14878
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014879table_gpc1(<table>)
14880 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14881 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14882 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14883 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14884 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14885
14886table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14887 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14888 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14889 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14890 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14891 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14892 sample fetch keyword.
14893
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014894table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14895 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14896 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014897 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014898 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14899 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14900
14901table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14902 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14903 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14904 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14905 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14906 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14907 keyword.
14908
14909table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14910 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14911 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014912 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014913 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14914 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14915
14916table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14917 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14918 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14919 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14920 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14921 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14922 keyword.
14923
14924table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14925 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14926 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014927 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014928 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14929 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14930 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14931 keyword.
14932
14933table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14934 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14935 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014936 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014937 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14938 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14939 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14940 keyword.
14941
14942table_server_id(<table>)
14943 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14944 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14945 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14946 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14947 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14948 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14949
14950table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14951 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14952 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014953 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014954 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14955 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14956 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14957 keyword.
14958
14959table_sess_rate(<table>)
14960 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14961 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14962 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14963 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14964 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14965 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14966 keyword.
14967
14968table_trackers(<table>)
14969 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14970 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14971 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14972 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14973 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14974 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14975 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14976 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14977 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14978 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14979
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014980upper
14981 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14982 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14983 type. The result is of type string.
14984
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020014985url_dec([<in_form>])
14986 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
14987 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
14988 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
14989 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
14990 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
14991 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014992
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014993ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014994 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014995 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14996 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14997 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014998 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14999 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15000 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15001 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015002 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015003 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15004 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015005
15006 Example:
15007 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
15008 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
15009
15010 message Point {
15011 int32 latitude = 1;
15012 int32 longitude = 2;
15013 }
15014
15015 message PPoint {
15016 Point point = 59;
15017 }
15018
15019 message Rectangle {
15020 // One corner of the rectangle.
15021 PPoint lo = 48;
15022 // The other corner of the rectangle.
15023 PPoint hi = 49;
15024 }
15025
15026 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
15027 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
15028 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
15029
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015030 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15031 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015032 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015033 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
15034
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015035 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015036
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015037 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015038
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015039 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015040 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15041 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
15042
15043 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
15044 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
15045 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
15046
15047 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
15048 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
15049 interpret the previous binary sample.
15050
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015051
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010015052unset-var(<var name>)
15053 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
15054 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
15055 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
15056 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15057 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
15058 response),
15059 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15060 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
15061 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
15062 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
15063
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015064utime(<format>[,<offset>])
15065 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15066 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
15067 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15068 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15069 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15070 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
15071
15072 Example :
15073
15074 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015075 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015076 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15077
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015078word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15079 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
15080 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
15081 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015082 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015083 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
15084 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
15085
15086 Example :
15087 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
15088 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15089 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
15090 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
15091 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015092 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010015093
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015094wt6([<avalanche>])
15095 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
15096 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15097 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15098 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15099 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15100 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15101 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015102 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
15103 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015104
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015105xor(<value>)
15106 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015107 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015108 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015109 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015110 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015111 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15112 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015113 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015114 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15115 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015116 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015117 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015118
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010015119xxh32([<seed>])
15120 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
15121 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15122 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15123 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15124 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15125 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15126 as cryptographically secure.
15127
15128xxh64([<seed>])
15129 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
15130 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15131 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15132 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15133 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15134 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15135 as cryptographically secure.
15136
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015137
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200151387.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015139--------------------------------------------
15140
15141A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
15142not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
15143"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
15144The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
15145
15146always_false : boolean
15147 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15148 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15149
15150always_true : boolean
15151 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15152 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15153
15154avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015155 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015156 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
15157 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
15158 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
15159 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
15160 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
15161 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
15162 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
15163 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
15164 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
15165 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
15166 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
15167 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
15168 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010015169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015170be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015171 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
15172 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
15173 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
15174 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015175 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
15176
15177be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
15178 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15179 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
15180 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
15181 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
15182 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015183 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
15184 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015185
15186 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
15187 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
15188 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015190be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
15191 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15192 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15193 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015194 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015195 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
15196 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015197
15198 Example :
15199 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
15200 backend dynamic
15201 mode http
15202 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
15203 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015204
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015205bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015206 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
15207 of the string.
15208
15209bool(<bool>) : bool
15210 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
15211 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
15212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015213connslots([<backend>]) : integer
15214 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015215 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015216 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
15217 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050015218
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015219 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015220 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015221 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
15222
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015223 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
15224 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015225
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015226 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015227 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015228 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015229 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015230 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015231 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015232 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015233
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015234 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
15235 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015236 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015237 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015238
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015239cpu_calls : integer
15240 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
15241 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
15242 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
15243 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
15244 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
15245 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
15246
15247cpu_ns_avg : integer
15248 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15249 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15250 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15251 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15252 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15253 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15254 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
15255 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
15256 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
15257 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
15258 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15259
15260cpu_ns_tot : integer
15261 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15262 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15263 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15264 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15265 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15266 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15267 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
15268 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
15269 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
15270 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
15271 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
15272 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
15273 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
15274
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015275date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015276 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015277
15278 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
15279 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
15280 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015281 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
15282
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015283 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
15284 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
15285 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
15286 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
15287 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
15288
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015289 Example :
15290
15291 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
15292 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015293
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015294 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
15295 # millisecond granularity
15296 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
15297
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010015298date_us : integer
15299 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
15300 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
15301 from the same timeval structure.
15302
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020015303distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
15304 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
15305 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
15306 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
15307 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
15308 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
15309 list of supported tokens.
15310
15311distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
15312 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
15313 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
15314 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
15315 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
15316 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
15317 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
15318 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
15319 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
15320 supported tokens.
15321
15322 Example :
15323 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
15324 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
15325 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
15326 # send large files to the big farm
15327 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
15328
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020015329env(<name>) : string
15330 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
15331 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
15332 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
15333 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
15334 certain way.
15335
15336 Examples :
15337 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
15338 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
15339
15340 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
15341 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
15342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015343fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
15344 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015345 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
15346 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015347 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
15348 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015349 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015350 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
15351 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015352
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020015353fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15354 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
15355 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
15356 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
15357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015358fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15359 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15360 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15361 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
15362 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
15363 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
15364 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
15365 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
15366 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015367
15368 Example :
15369 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
15370 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
15371 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
15372 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
15373 frontend mail
15374 bind :25
15375 mode tcp
15376 maxconn 100
15377 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
15378 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
15379 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
15380 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015381
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010015382hostname : string
15383 Returns the system hostname.
15384
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015385int(<integer>) : signed integer
15386 Returns a signed integer.
15387
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015388ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
15389 Returns an ipv4.
15390
15391ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
15392 Returns an ipv6.
15393
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015394lat_ns_avg : integer
15395 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15396 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15397 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15398 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15399 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15400 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15401 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15402 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15403 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
15404 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
15405 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
15406 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15407 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
15408 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15409
15410lat_ns_tot : integer
15411 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15412 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15413 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15414 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15415 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15416 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15417 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15418 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15419 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
15420 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
15421 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
15422 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15423 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
15424 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
15425 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
15426 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
15427 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
15428 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
15429 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
15430
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015431meth(<method>) : method
15432 Returns a method.
15433
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015434nbproc : integer
15435 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
15436 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
15437 and debugging purposes.
15438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015439nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
15440 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
15441 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
15442 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015443 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
15444 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
15445 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015446
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040015447prio_class : integer
15448 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
15449 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
15450 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
15451
15452prio_offset : integer
15453 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
15454 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
15455 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
15456 set-priority-offset".
15457
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015458proc : integer
15459 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
15460 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
15461 debugging purposes.
15462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015463queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015464 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
15465 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
15466 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015467 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
15468 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
15469 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
15470 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
15471 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
15472
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010015473rand([<range>]) : integer
15474 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
15475 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
15476 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
15477 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
15478 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
15479
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020015480uuid([<version>]) : string
15481 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
15482 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
15483 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
15484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015485srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15486 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15487 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
15488 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
15489 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
15490 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015491 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
15492 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
15493
15494srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15495 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15496 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
15497 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15498 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
15499 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
15500 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
15501 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
15502
15503 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
15504 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015505
15506srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
15507 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
15508 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
15509 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015510 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015511 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
15512 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
15513 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
15514
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020015515srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15516 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
15517 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15518 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
15519 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
15520 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
15521 fetch methods.
15522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015523srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15524 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15525 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015526 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015527 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
15528 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015529 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015530 overloading servers).
15531
15532 Example :
15533 # Redirect to a separate back
15534 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
15535 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
15536 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
15537
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015538stopping : boolean
15539 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
15540 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
15541 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
15542
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015543str(<string>) : string
15544 Returns a string.
15545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015546table_avl([<table>]) : integer
15547 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
15548 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
15549
15550table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15551 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
15552 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
15553 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
15554
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010015555thread : integer
15556 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
15557 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
15558 and debugging purposes.
15559
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015560var(<var-name>) : undefined
15561 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015562 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
15563 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015564 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015565 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15566 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015567 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015568 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15569 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015570 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015571 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015572
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200155737.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015574----------------------------------
15575
15576The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
15577closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
15578methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
15579sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
15580TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015581the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
15582counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020015583"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
15584used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
15585can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
15586Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
15587table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
15588tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
15589currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015590
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010015591bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010015592 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15593 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15594 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
15595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015596be_id : integer
15597 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
15598 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15599
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015600be_name : string
15601 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
15602 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015604dst : ip
15605 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
15606 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
15607 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
15608 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015609 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
15610 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
15611 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
15612 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
15613 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
15614 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015615
15616dst_conn : integer
15617 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15618 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
15619 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
15620 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
15621 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
15622 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
15623 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
15624 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015625
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015626dst_is_local : boolean
15627 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
15628 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
15629 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
15630 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015631 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015632 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
15633 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
15634 it only once per connection.
15635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015636dst_port : integer
15637 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
15638 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
15639 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
15640 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
15641 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
15642 an HTTP header.
15643
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020015644fc_http_major : integer
15645 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15646 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15647 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
15648
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020015649fc_pp_authority : string
15650 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
15651 if any.
15652
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010015653fc_pp_unique_id : string
15654 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
15655 if any.
15656
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010015657fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
15658 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
15659 header.
15660
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020015661fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
15662 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
15663 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
15664 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
15665 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15666 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15667 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15668
15669fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
15670 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
15671 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
15672 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
15673 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15674 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15675 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15676
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015677fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015678 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15679 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15680 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15681 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15682
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015683fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015684 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15685 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15686 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15687 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15688
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015689fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015690 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
15691 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15692 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15693 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15694
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015695fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015696 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
15697 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15698 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15699 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15700
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015701fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015702 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
15703 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15704 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15705 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15706
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015707fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015708 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
15709 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15710 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15711 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15712
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020015713fe_defbe : string
15714 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
15715 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
15716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015717fe_id : integer
15718 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010015719 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015720 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15721
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015722fe_name : string
15723 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
15724 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
15725 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15726
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015727sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015728sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15729sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15730sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015731 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
15732 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15733 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
15734
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015735sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015736sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15737sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15738sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015739 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
15740 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15741 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
15742
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015743sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015744sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15745sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15746sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015747 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15748 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015749 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15750 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15751 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015752
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015753 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015754 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15755 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015756 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15757 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15758 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015759 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15760 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15761
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015762sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15763sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15764sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15765sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15766 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15767 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15768 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15769 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15770 when a first ACL was verified.
15771
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015772sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015773sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15774sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15775sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015776 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015777 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15778
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015779sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015780sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15781sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15782sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015783 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15784 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15785 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15786
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015787sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015788sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15789sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15790sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015791 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15792 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15793 See also src_conn_rate.
15794
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015795sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015796sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15797sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15798sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015799 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015800 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015801
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015802sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15803sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15804sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15805sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15806 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15807 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15808
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015809sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15810sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15811sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15812sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15813 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15814 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15815
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015816sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015817sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15818sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15819sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015820 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15821 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15822 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015823 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15824 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15825 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015826
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015827sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15828sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15829sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15830sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15831 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15832 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15833 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15834 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15835 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15836 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15837
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015838sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015839sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15840sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15841sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015842 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015843 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15844 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15845
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015846sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015847sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15848sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15849sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015850 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15851 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15852 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15853 src_http_err_rate.
15854
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015855sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015856sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15857sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15858sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015859 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015860 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15861 src_http_req_cnt.
15862
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015863sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015864sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15865sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15866sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015867 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15868 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15869 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15870 src_http_req_rate.
15871
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015872sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015873sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15874sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15875sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015876 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015877 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15878 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15879 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15880 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015881
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015882 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015883 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15884 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015885 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15886
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015887sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15888sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15889sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15890sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15891 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15892 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15893 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15894 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15895 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15896
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015897sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015898sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15899sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15900sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015901 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15902 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15903 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015904
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015905sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015906sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15907sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15908sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015909 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15910 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15911 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015912
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015913sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015914sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15915sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15916sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015917 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015918 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15919 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15920 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015921 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015922 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15923
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015924sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015925sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15926sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15927sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015928 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15929 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15930 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15931 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15932 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015933 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015934
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015935sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015936sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15937sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15938sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015939 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15940 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15941 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15942
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015943sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015944sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15945sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15946sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015947 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15948 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015949 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015950 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15951 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015952 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15953 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15954 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015956so_id : integer
15957 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15958 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15959 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015960
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010015961so_name : string
15962 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
15963 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
15964 strings instead of integers.
15965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015966src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015967 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015968 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15969 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15970 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015971 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15972 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15973 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015974 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15975 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15976 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15977 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15978 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15979 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15980 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015981
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015982 Example:
15983 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15984 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015986src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15987 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15988 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15989 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015990 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015992src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15993 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15994 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015995 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015996 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015998src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15999 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16000 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16001 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16002 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16003 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16004 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016005
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016006 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016007 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16008 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
16009 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
16010 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016011 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016012 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16013 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16014
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016015src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16016 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16017 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16018 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16019 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16020 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16021 was verified.
16022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016023src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016024 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016025 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016026 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016027 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016029src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016030 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016031 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16032 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016033 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016035src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16036 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
16037 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16038 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016039 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016041src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016042 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016043 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016044 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016045 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016046
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016047src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16048 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16049 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16050 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16051 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
16052
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016053src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16054 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16055 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16056 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16057 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
16058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016059src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016060 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016061 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016062 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16063 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016064 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16065 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16066 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016067
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016068src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16069 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16070 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16071 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16072 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16073 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16074 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16075 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016077src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016078 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016079 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016080 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016081 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016082 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016084src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16085 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
16086 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16087 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16088 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016089 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016091src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016092 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016093 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16094 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016095 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016097src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16098 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
16099 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16100 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016101 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016102 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016104src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16105 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16106 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16107 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016108 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016109 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16110 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016111
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016112 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016113 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016114 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016115 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016116
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016117src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16118 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16119 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16120 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
16121 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16122 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16123 connection when a first ACL was verified.
16124
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016125src_is_local : boolean
16126 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
16127 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
16128 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
16129 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016130 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016131 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
16132 once per connection.
16133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016134src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016135 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
16136 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
16137 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
16138 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
16139 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016141src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016142 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
16143 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16144 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
16145 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
16146 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016148src_port : integer
16149 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
16150 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
16151 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
16152 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016154src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016155 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016156 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16157 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
16158 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016159 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016161src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16162 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
16163 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16164 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16165 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016166 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016168src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16169 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
16170 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
16171 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
16172 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
16173 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
16174 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
16175 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
16176 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016177
16178 Example :
16179 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
16180 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
16181 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
16182 listen ssh
16183 bind :22
16184 mode tcp
16185 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016186 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016187 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016188 server local 127.0.0.1:22
16189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016190srv_id : integer
16191 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
16192 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
16193 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020016194
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016195srv_name : string
16196 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
16197 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
16198 debugging.
16199
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200162007.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016201----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020016202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016203The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
16204closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
16205when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
16206usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016207future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016208
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001620951d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
16210 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16211 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16212 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
16213 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16214 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16215
16216 Example :
16217 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
16218 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
16219 # the request.
16220 frontend http-in
16221 bind *:8081
16222 default_backend servers
16223 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16224 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16225
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016226ssl_bc : boolean
16227 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16228 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
16229 other a server with the "ssl" option.
16230
16231ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
16232 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
16233 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16234
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016235ssl_bc_alpn : string
16236 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
16237 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016238 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016239 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16240 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16241 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
16242 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
16243 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
16244 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
16245
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016246ssl_bc_cipher : string
16247 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
16248 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16249
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016250ssl_bc_client_random : binary
16251 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16252 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16253 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16254
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010016255ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
16256 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16257 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
16258 session or a TLS ticket.
16259
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016260ssl_bc_npn : string
16261 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
16262 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016263 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016264 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
16265 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
16266 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
16267 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
16268 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
16269
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016270ssl_bc_protocol : string
16271 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
16272 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16273
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016274ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016275 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016276 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16277 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016278
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016279ssl_bc_server_random : binary
16280 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16281 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16282 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16283
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016284ssl_bc_session_id : binary
16285 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
16286 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
16287 if session was reused or not.
16288
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016289ssl_bc_session_key : binary
16290 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
16291 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16292 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16293 BoringSSL.
16294
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016295ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
16296 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
16297 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016299ssl_c_ca_err : integer
16300 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16301 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
16302 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
16303 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
16304 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016306ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
16307 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16308 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
16309 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
16310 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016311
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016312ssl_c_der : binary
16313 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
16314 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16315 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016317ssl_c_err : integer
16318 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16319 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
16320 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
16321 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
16322 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016323
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016324ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016325 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16326 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16327 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16328 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16329 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16330 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16331 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16332 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016333 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16334 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16335 LDAP v3.
16336 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16337 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016339ssl_c_key_alg : string
16340 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16341 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16342 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016344ssl_c_notafter : string
16345 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
16346 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16347 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016349ssl_c_notbefore : string
16350 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
16351 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16352 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016353
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016354ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016355 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16356 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16357 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16358 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16359 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16360 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16361 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16362 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016363 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16364 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16365 LDAP v3.
16366 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16367 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016369ssl_c_serial : binary
16370 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
16371 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16372 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016374ssl_c_sha1 : binary
16375 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
16376 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
16377 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016378 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
16379 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
16380
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016381 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016382 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016384ssl_c_sig_alg : string
16385 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16386 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16387 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016389ssl_c_used : boolean
16390 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
16391 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016393ssl_c_verify : integer
16394 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
16395 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
16396 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
16397 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016399ssl_c_version : integer
16400 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
16401 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016402
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016403ssl_f_der : binary
16404 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
16405 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16406 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16407
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016408ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016409 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16410 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16411 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16412 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016413 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016414 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16415 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16416 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016417 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16418 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16419 LDAP v3.
16420 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16421 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016423ssl_f_key_alg : string
16424 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16425 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
16426 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016428ssl_f_notafter : string
16429 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16430 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16431 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016433ssl_f_notbefore : string
16434 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16435 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16436 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016437
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016438ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016439 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16440 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16441 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16442 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16443 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16444 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16445 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16446 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016447 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16448 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16449 LDAP v3.
16450 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16451 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016453ssl_f_serial : binary
16454 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16455 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16456 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016457
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020016458ssl_f_sha1 : binary
16459 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
16460 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
16461 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
16462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016463ssl_f_sig_alg : string
16464 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16465 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16466 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016468ssl_f_version : integer
16469 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16470 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16471
16472ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016473 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16474 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
16475 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
16476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016477 Example :
16478 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
16479 listen http-https
16480 bind :80
16481 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
16482 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
16483
16484ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
16485 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
16486 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16487
16488ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016489 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016490 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
16491 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
16492 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16493 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16494 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
16495 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
16496 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
16497 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
16498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016499ssl_fc_cipher : string
16500 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
16501 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020016502
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016503ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
16504 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
16505 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016506 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016507
16508ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
16509 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
16510 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016511 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016512
16513ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
16514 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
16515 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
16516 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016517 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020016518 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016519
16520ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
16521 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
16522 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016523 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016524
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016525ssl_fc_client_random : binary
16526 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16527 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16528 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016530ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016531 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
16532 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010016533 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
16534 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
16535 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
16536 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016537
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020016538ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
16539 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
16540 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
16541 wait until the handshake happened.
16542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016543ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
16544 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016545 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
16546 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016547 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016548 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016549
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020016550ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016551 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010016552 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
16553 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016555ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016556 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016557 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
16558 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
16559 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
16560 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
16561 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
16562 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
16563 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020016564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016565ssl_fc_protocol : string
16566 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
16567 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016568
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016569ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016570 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016571 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16572 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016573
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016574ssl_fc_server_random : binary
16575 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16576 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16577 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016579ssl_fc_session_id : binary
16580 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
16581 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
16582 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
16583 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016584
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016585ssl_fc_session_key : binary
16586 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
16587 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16588 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16589 BoringSSL.
16590
16591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016592ssl_fc_sni : string
16593 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
16594 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
16595 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
16596 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
16597 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
16598
16599 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
16600 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
16601 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016602 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020016603 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016605 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016606 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
16607 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020016608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016609ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
16610 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
16611 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016612
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016613
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200166147.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016615------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016617Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
16618sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
16619only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
16620For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
16621be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
16622can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
16623sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
16624for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
16625content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016627payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016628 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016629 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
16630 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016632payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
16633 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016634 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016635 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016636
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020016637req.hdrs : string
16638 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
16639 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
16640 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
16641 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
16642
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020016643req.hdrs_bin : binary
16644 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
16645 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
16646 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
16647 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
16648 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
16649 names and values (length of 0 for both).
16650
16651 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
16652
16653 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
16654 str: <int:length><bytes>
16655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016656req.len : integer
16657req_len : integer (deprecated)
16658 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16659 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16660 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16661 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16662 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16663 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16664 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
16665 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016667req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16668 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016669 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16670 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16671 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16672 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016674 ACL alternatives :
16675 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016677req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16678 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16679 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16680 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
16681 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016683 ACL alternatives :
16684 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016686 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016688req.proto_http : boolean
16689req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
16690 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
16691 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
16692 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
16693 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
16694 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
16695 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
16696 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016698 Example:
16699 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
16700 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16701 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016702 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016704req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
16705rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16706 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
16707 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
16708 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
16709 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
16710 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
16711 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
16712 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016714 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
16715 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
16716 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
16717 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
16718 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
16719 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016721 ACL derivatives :
16722 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016724 Example :
16725 listen tse-farm
16726 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
16727 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
16728 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16729 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
16730 # apply RDP cookie persistence
16731 persist rdp-cookie
16732 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
16733 # This is only useful makes sense if
16734 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
16735 stick-table type string size 204800
16736 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
16737 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
16738 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016740 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
16741 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016743req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
16744rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
16745 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
16746 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
16747 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
16748 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016750 ACL derivatives :
16751 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016752
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016753req.ssl_alpn : string
16754 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
16755 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
16756 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
16757 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
16758 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
16759 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016760 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016761
16762 Examples :
16763 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16764 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16765 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016766 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016767 default_backend bk_default
16768
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016769req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
16770 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
16771 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016772 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
16773 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
16774 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16775 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16776 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016778req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16779req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16780 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16781 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16782 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16783 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16784 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16785 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16786 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016788req.ssl_sni : string
16789req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16790 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16791 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16792 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16793 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16794 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16795 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16796 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16797 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16798 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16799 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16800 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16801 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016803 ACL derivatives :
16804 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016806 Examples :
16807 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16808 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16809 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16810 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16811 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016812
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016813req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16814 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16815 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16816 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16817 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16818 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16819 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16820 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16821 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16822 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016824req.ssl_ver : integer
16825req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16826 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16827 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16828 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16829 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16830 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16831 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16832 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016833 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016834 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016836 ACL derivatives :
16837 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016838
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020016839res.len : integer
16840 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16841 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16842 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16843 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16844 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16845 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16846 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
16847 content inspection.
16848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016849res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16850 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016851 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16852 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16853 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16854 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016856res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16857 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16858 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16859 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
16860 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016862 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016863
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020016864res.ssl_hello_type : integer
16865rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16866 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16867 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
16868 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16869 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16870 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
16871 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16872 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016874wait_end : boolean
16875 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16876 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016877 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016878 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16879 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016880 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016881 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16882 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016884 Examples :
16885 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16886 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16887 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016889 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16890 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16891 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16892 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16893 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16894 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16895 tcp-request content reject
16896
16897
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200168987.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016899--------------------------------------
16900
16901It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16902This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16903data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16904its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16905HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16906content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16907to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16908more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16909response are indexed.
16910
16911base : string
16912 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16913 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16914 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16915 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16916 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16917 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16918 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16919 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16920
16921 ACL derivatives :
16922 base : exact string match
16923 base_beg : prefix match
16924 base_dir : subdir match
16925 base_dom : domain match
16926 base_end : suffix match
16927 base_len : length match
16928 base_reg : regex match
16929 base_sub : substring match
16930
16931base32 : integer
16932 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16933 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16934 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016935 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16936 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16937 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016938
16939base32+src : binary
16940 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16941 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16942 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16943 per-URL counters.
16944
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016945capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16946 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16947 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16948 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16949
16950capture.req.method : string
16951 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16952 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16953 because it's allocated.
16954
16955capture.req.uri : string
16956 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16957 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16958 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16959 allocated.
16960
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016961capture.req.ver : string
16962 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16963 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16964 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16965
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016966capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16967 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16968 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16969 The first entry is an index of 0.
16970 See also: "capture response header"
16971
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016972capture.res.ver : string
16973 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16974 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16975 persistent flag.
16976
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016977req.body : binary
16978 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16979 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16980 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16981 the first chunk is analyzed.
16982
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016983req.body_param([<name>) : string
16984 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16985 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16986 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16987 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16988 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16989 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16990 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16991 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16992 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16993 given.
16994
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016995req.body_len : integer
16996 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16997 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16998 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16999 "option http-buffer-request".
17000
17001req.body_size : integer
17002 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
17003 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
17004 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
17005 that the request body has been buffered made available using
17006 "option http-buffer-request".
17007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017008req.cook([<name>]) : string
17009cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17010 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17011 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
17012 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
17013 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
17014 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
17015 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
17016 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
17017 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
17018
17019 ACL derivatives :
17020 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
17021 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
17022 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
17023 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
17024 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
17025 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
17026 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
17027 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017029req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17030cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17031 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17032 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017034req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17035cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17036 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17037 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
17038 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
17039 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017041cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17042 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17043 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
17044 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
17045 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017046 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017047 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
17048 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
17049 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
17050 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017052hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17053 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
17054 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
17055 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
17056 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017057 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017059req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
17060 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17061 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17062 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17063 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17064 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17065 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
17066 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
17067 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017069req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17070 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17071 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17072 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17073 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017075req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17076 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17077 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17078 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17079 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17080 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17081 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
17082 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
17083 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000017084 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017085 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017086 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017088 ACL derivatives :
17089 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17090 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17091 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17092 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17093 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17094 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17095 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17096 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17097
17098req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17099hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
17100 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17101 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
17102 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
17103 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
17104 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
17105 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
17106 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
17107 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
17108 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
17109
17110req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17111hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17112 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
17113 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
17114 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
17115 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
17116 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017117 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017118 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
17119 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
17120
17121req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
17122hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
17123 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
17124 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
17125 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
17126 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17127 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17128 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17129 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
17130
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010017131
17132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017133http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
17134 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
17135 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
17136 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
17137 basic auth is supported.
17138
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010017139http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
17140 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
17141 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
17142 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
17143 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017144 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
17145 basic auth is supported.
17146
17147 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010017148 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
17149 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
17150 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
17151 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017152
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017153http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017154 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
17155 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
17156 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017157
17158http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017159 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
17160 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
17161 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017162
17163http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017164 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
17165 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
17166 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017168http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020017169 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
17170 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017171 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
17172 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020017173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017174method : integer + string
17175 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
17176 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
17177 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
17178 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
17179 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
17180 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
17181 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017183 ACL derivatives :
17184 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017186 Example :
17187 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
17188 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
17189 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017191path : string
17192 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
17193 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
17194 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
17195 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
17196 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017197 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017198 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017200 ACL derivatives :
17201 path : exact string match
17202 path_beg : prefix match
17203 path_dir : subdir match
17204 path_dom : domain match
17205 path_end : suffix match
17206 path_len : length match
17207 path_reg : regex match
17208 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017209
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010017210query : string
17211 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
17212 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
17213 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
17214 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017215 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010017216 which stops before the question mark.
17217
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017218req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
17219 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
17220 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
17221 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
17222 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
17223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017224req.ver : string
17225req_ver : string (deprecated)
17226 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
17227 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
17228 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017230 ACL derivatives :
17231 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017233res.comp : boolean
17234 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
17235 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
17236 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017238res.comp_algo : string
17239 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
17240 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
17241 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017243res.cook([<name>]) : string
17244scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17245 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17246 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
17247 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020017248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017249 ACL derivatives :
17250 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020017251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017252res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17253scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17254 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17255 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
17256 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017258res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17259scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17260 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17261 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
17262 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017264res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17265 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17266 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17267 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17268 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17269 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
17270 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
17271 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
17272 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
17273 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017275res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17276 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17277 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17278 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17279 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
17280 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017282res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17283shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
17284 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17285 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17286 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17287 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17288 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
17289 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
17290 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
17291 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017293 ACL derivatives :
17294 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17295 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17296 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17297 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17298 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17299 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17300 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17301 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17302
17303res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17304shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17305 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17306 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17307 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
17308 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
17309 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017311res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17312shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17313 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
17314 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
17315 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
17316 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
17317 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
17318 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017319
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017320res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
17321 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
17322 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
17323 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
17324 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
17325
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017326res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
17327shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
17328 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
17329 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
17330 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
17331 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
17332 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
17333 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010017334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017335res.ver : string
17336resp_ver : string (deprecated)
17337 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
17338 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017340 ACL derivatives :
17341 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010017342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017343set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17344 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17345 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017346 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017347 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017349 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
17350 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017352status : integer
17353 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
17354 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
17355 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017356
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020017357unique-id : string
17358 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
17359 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
17360 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
17361 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
17362 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
17363 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
17364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017365url : string
17366 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
17367 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
17368 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
17369 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
17370 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
17371 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
17372 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017374 ACL derivatives :
17375 url : exact string match
17376 url_beg : prefix match
17377 url_dir : subdir match
17378 url_dom : domain match
17379 url_end : suffix match
17380 url_len : length match
17381 url_reg : regex match
17382 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017384url_ip : ip
17385 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
17386 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
17387 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
17388 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
17389 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
17390 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
17391 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017393url_port : integer
17394 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
17395 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
17396 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
17397 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017398
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017399urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
17400url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017401 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
17402 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017403 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
17404 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
17405 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
17406 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017407 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
17408 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017409 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
17410 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017412 ACL derivatives :
17413 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
17414 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
17415 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
17416 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
17417 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
17418 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
17419 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
17420 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017421
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017423 Example :
17424 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
17425 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
17426 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
17427 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017428
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017429urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017430 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
17431 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
17432 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020017433
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020017434url32 : integer
17435 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
17436 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
17437 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
17438 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
17439 is an unsigned integer.
17440
17441url32+src : binary
17442 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
17443 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
17444 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
17445
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010017446
Christopher Fauletba3c68f2020-04-01 16:27:05 +0200174477.3.7. Fetching health-check samples
17448-------------------------------------
17449
17450This set of sample fetch methods may be called from an health-check execution
17451context. It was introduced in the version 2.2. The following sample fetches are
17452placed in the dedicated scope "check". Other sample fetches may also be called
17453when an health-check is performed if it makes sense and if the sample fetch was
17454adapted to be called in this context.
17455
17456check.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17457 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
17458 in the check input buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is
17459 zero, then the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can
17460 be called from a tcp-check expect rule, or eventually from a set-var rule
17461 after an expect rule and before a send rule (check input buffer is filled on
17462 tcp-check expect rules and reset on tcp-check send rules).
17463
17464
174657.3.8. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017466---------------------------------------
17467
17468This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
17469used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
17470purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
17471There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
17472or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
17473any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
17474for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
17475
17476internal.htx.data : integer
17477 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
17478 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17479
17480internal.htx.free : integer
17481 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
17482 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17483
17484internal.htx.free_data : integer
17485 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
17486 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17487
17488internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
17489 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
17490 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
17491 chosen depending on the sample direction.
17492
17493internal.htx.nbblks : integer
17494 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
17495 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17496
17497internal.htx.size : integer
17498 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
17499 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17500
17501internal.htx.used : integer
17502 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
17503 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17504 direction.
17505
17506internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
17507 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17508 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
17509 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
17510 of the special value :
17511 * head : The oldest inserted block
17512 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017513 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017514
17515internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
17516 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17517 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
17518 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
17519 integer or one of the special value :
17520 * head : The oldest inserted block
17521 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017522 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017523
17524internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
17525 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17526 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
17527 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17528 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17529
17530 * head : The oldest inserted block
17531 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017532 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017533
17534internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
17535 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
17536 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
17537 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17538 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17539
17540 * head : The oldest inserted block
17541 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017542 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017543
17544internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
17545 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
17546 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
17547 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17548 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17549
17550 * head : The oldest inserted block
17551 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017552 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017553
17554internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
17555 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
17556 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
17557 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17558 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17559
17560 * head : The oldest inserted block
17561 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017562 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017563
17564internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
17565 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
17566 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
17567 it returns false.
17568
17569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200175707.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017571---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017572
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017573Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
17574every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020017575order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017576
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017577ACL name Equivalent to Usage
17578---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017579FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020017580HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017581HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
17582HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017583HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
17584HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
17585HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
17586HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
17587LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017588METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017589METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017590METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
17591METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
17592METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
17593METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017594METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017595METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017596RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017597REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017598TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017599WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
17600---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017601
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010017602
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176038. Logging
17604----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017605
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017606One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
17607provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
17608very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
17609provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
17610state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017611to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017612headers.
17613
17614In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
17615about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
17616send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
17617
17618 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
17619 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
17620 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
17621 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
17622 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017623 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060017624 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017625
17626The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
17627allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
17628as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
17629while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
17630real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
17631delay.
17632
17633
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176348.1. Log levels
17635---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017636
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017637TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017638source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017639HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
17640in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
17641track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
17642syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
17643about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017644
17645
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176468.2. Log formats
17647----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017648
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017649HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017650and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
17651slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
17652options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017653
17654 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
17655 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
17656 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
17657 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
17658 extents.
17659
17660 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
17661 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
17662 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
17663 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
17664 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
17665
17666 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
17667 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
17668 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
17669 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
17670 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
17671
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020017672 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
17673 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
17674 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
17675 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
17676
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017677 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
17678
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017679Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
17680specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
17681field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
17682servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
17683always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
17684identifier.
17685
17686Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
17687 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
17688 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
17689 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
17690 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
17691
17692
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176938.2.1. Default log format
17694-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017695
17696This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
17697as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
17698format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
17699
17700 Example :
17701 listen www
17702 mode http
17703 log global
17704 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17705
17706 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
17707 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
17708 (www/HTTP)
17709
17710 Field Format Extract from the example above
17711 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
17712 2 'Connect from' Connect from
17713 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
17714 4 'to' to
17715 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
17716 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
17717
17718Detailed fields description :
17719 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
17720 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
17721 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
17722 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
17723 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17724 and processed the connection.
17725 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
17726
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017727In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
17728"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
17729connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
17730
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017731It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
17732will eventually disappear.
17733
17734
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177358.2.2. TCP log format
17736---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017737
17738The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
17739is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
17740information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
17741counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
17742emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
17743environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
17744the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
17745sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017746specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
17747not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
17748fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
17749marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017750
17751 Example :
17752 frontend fnt
17753 mode tcp
17754 option tcplog
17755 log global
17756 default_backend bck
17757
17758 backend bck
17759 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17760
17761 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
17762 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
17763 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
17764
17765 Field Format Extract from the example above
17766 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
17767 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
17768 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
17769 4 frontend_name fnt
17770 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
17771 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
17772 7 bytes_read* 212
17773 8 termination_state --
17774 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
17775 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17776
17777Detailed fields description :
17778 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017779 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17780 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17781 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017782 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017783 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017784 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017785
17786 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017787 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17788 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17789 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017790
17791 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
17792 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
17793 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017794 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
17795 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
17796 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
17797 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017798
17799 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17800 and processed the connection.
17801
17802 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17803 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17804 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
17805 applications.
17806
17807 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17808 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17809 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17810 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
17811 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
17812
17813 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17814 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
17815 See "Timers" below for more details.
17816
17817 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17818 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
17819 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
17820 "Timers" below for more details.
17821
17822 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017823 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017824 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
17825 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
17826 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
17827 details.
17828
17829 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
17830 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
17831 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
17832 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
17833 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
17834
17835 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17836 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17837 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
17838 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
17839 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
17840 for more details.
17841
17842 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017843 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017844 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
17845 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
17846 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017847 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017848
17849 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17850 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17851 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17852 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17853 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17854 caused by a denial of service attack.
17855
17856 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17857 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17858 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17859 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17860 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17861 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17862 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17863 denial of service attack.
17864
17865 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17866 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17867 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17868 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17869 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17870 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17871 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17872 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
17873 be processed than on other servers.
17874
17875 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17876 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17877 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17878 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17879 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17880 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17881 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17882 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17883 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17884 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17885 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17886 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17887 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17888
17889 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17890 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17891 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17892 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17893 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17894 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017895 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017896 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17897
17898 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17899 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17900 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17901 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17902 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17903 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017904 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017905 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17906 occurs.
17907
17908
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179098.2.3. HTTP log format
17910----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017911
17912The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
17913is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
17914the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
17915are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
17916emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
17917generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
17918"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
17919which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017920frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
17921is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017922
17923Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
17924slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
17925with a star ('*') after the field name below.
17926
17927 Example :
17928 frontend http-in
17929 mode http
17930 option httplog
17931 log global
17932 default_backend bck
17933
17934 backend static
17935 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17936
17937 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
17938 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
17939 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017940 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017941
17942 Field Format Extract from the example above
17943 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17944 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017945 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017946 4 frontend_name http-in
17947 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017948 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017949 7 status_code 200
17950 8 bytes_read* 2750
17951 9 captured_request_cookie -
17952 10 captured_response_cookie -
17953 11 termination_state ----
17954 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
17955 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17956 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
17957 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
17958 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017959
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017960Detailed fields description :
17961 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017962 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17963 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17964 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017965 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017966 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017967 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017968
17969 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017970 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17971 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17972 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017973
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017974 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17975 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017976
17977 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17978 and processed the connection.
17979
17980 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17981 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17982 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17983
17984 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17985 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17986 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17987 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17988 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17989 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17990
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017991 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17992 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17993 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017994 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017995 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17996 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017997 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17998 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017999
18000 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18001 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018002 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018003
18004 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18005 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018006 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
18007 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018008
18009 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
18010 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
18011 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
18012 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
18013 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018014 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
18015 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018016
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018017 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
18018 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
18019 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
18020 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
18021 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
18022 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
18023 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018024 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018025
18026 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
18027 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
18028 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
18029
18030 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
18031 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018032 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018033 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
18034 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
18035 overflowing.
18036
18037 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
18038 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
18039 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
18040 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
18041 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
18042 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
18043 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
18044 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18045
18046 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
18047 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
18048 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
18049 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
18050 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
18051 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
18052 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
18053 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18054
18055 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18056 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18057 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
18058 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
18059 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
18060 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
18061 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
18062
18063 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018064 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018065 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
18066 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
18067 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018068 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018069 system.
18070
18071 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18072 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18073 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18074 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18075 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18076 caused by a denial of service attack.
18077
18078 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18079 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18080 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18081 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18082 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18083 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18084 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18085 denial of service attack.
18086
18087 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18088 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18089 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18090 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18091 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18092 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18093 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18094 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
18095 processed than on other servers.
18096
18097 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18098 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18099 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18100 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18101 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18102 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18103 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18104 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18105 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18106 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18107 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18108 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18109 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18110
18111 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18112 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18113 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18114 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18115 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18116 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018117 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018118 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18119
18120 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18121 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18122 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18123 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18124 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18125 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018126 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018127 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18128 occurs.
18129
18130 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
18131 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
18132 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
18133 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
18134 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
18135 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
18136 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
18137 cookies" below for more details.
18138
18139 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
18140 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
18141 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
18142 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
18143 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
18144 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
18145 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
18146 and cookies" below for more details.
18147
18148 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
18149 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
18150 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
18151 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
18152 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
18153 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
18154 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
18155 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
18156
18157
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200181588.2.4. Custom log format
18159------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018160
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018161The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018162mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018163
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018164HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018165Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
18166separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
18167prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
18168
18169Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
18170variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018171("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018172
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010018173If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020018174as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010018175less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
18176the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
18177
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018178Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018179In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010018180in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018181
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018182Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
18183'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
18184https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
18185such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
18186
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018187Flags are :
18188 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018189 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018190 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
18191 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018192
18193 Example:
18194
18195 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
18196 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
18197
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018198 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
18199
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018200At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
18201
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018202 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
18203 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018204
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018205the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018206
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018207 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
18208 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
18209 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018210
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018211and the default TCP format is defined this way :
18212
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018213 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
18214 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018215
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018216Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
18217
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018218 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018219 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018220 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
18221 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
18222 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018223 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
18224 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
18225 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018226 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000018227 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
18228 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000018229 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000018230 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
18231 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010018232 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020018233 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018234 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018235 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018236 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020018237 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080018238 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018239 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
18240 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
18241 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
18242 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
18243 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018244 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018245 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000018246 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018247 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018248 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018249 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
18250 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018251 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
18252 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
18253 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018254 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018255 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
18256 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018257 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018258 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
18259 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
18260 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020018261 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020018262 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018263 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
18264 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
18265 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
18266 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020018267 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018268 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018269 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018270 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010018271 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018272 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018273 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
18274 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
18275 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018276 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018277 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
18278 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018279 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018280 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
18281 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020018282 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018283 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018284 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018285 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018286
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018287 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018288
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018289
182908.2.5. Error log format
18291-----------------------
18292
18293When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
18294protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
18295By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
18296"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018297will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018298logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
18299
18300The format looks like this :
18301
18302 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
18303 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
18304 Connection error during SSL handshake
18305
18306 Field Format Extract from the example above
18307 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
18308 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
18309 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
18310 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
18311 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
18312
18313These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
18314failures.
18315
18316
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183178.3. Advanced logging options
18318-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018319
18320Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
18321just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
18322options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
18323for more information about their usage.
18324
18325
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183268.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
18327------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018328
18329It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
18330haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
18331commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
18332monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
18333ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
18334
18335 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
18336 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
18337 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
18338 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
18339
18340 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
18341 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
18342 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018343 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018344 such as other load-balancers.
18345
18346 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
18347 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
18348 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
18349
18350
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183518.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
18352----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018353
18354The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
18355what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
18356or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018357"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018358just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
18359log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
18360after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
18361is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
18362with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
18363with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
18364
18365
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183668.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
18367------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018368
18369Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
18370for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
18371"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
18372retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
18373raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
18374a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
18375file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
18376you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
18377"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
18378
18379
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183808.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
18381--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018382
18383Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
18384multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
18385them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
18386"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
18387logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
18388error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
18389and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
18390too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
18391useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
18392alternative.
18393
18394
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183958.4. Timing events
18396------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018397
18398Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
18399reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
18400the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
18401frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018402mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
18403addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
18404
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010018405Timings events in HTTP mode:
18406
18407 first request 2nd request
18408 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
18409 t tr t tr ...
18410 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
18411 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
18412 :<---- Tq ---->: :
18413 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000018414 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010018415 :<--------- Ta --------->:
18416
18417Timings events in TCP mode:
18418
18419 TCP session
18420 |<----------------->|
18421 t t
18422 ---|----|----|----|----|---
18423 | Th Tw Tc Td |
18424 |<------ Tt ------->|
18425
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018426 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018427 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018428 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
18429 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
18430 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018431 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018432 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
18433 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
18434 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
18435 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018436
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018437 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
18438 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
18439 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018440 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
18441 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
18442 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
18443 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
18444 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
18445 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018446
18447 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
18448 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
18449 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
18450 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
18451 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
18452 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
18453 request typed by hand during a test.
18454
18455 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
18456 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018457 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018458 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
18459 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
18460 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
18461 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018462
18463 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
18464 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
18465 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
18466 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
18467 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
18468
18469 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
18470 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
18471 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
18472 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
18473 connection never established.
18474
18475 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
18476 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
18477 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
18478 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
18479 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
18480 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
18481 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
18482 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
18483 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
18484 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
18485 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
18486
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018487 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
18488 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
18489 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
18490 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
18491 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
18492 by subtracting other timers when valid :
18493
18494 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
18495
18496 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
18497 "Ta" can never be negative.
18498
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018499 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
18500 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018501 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
18502 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018503 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018504
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018505 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018506
18507 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018508 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
18509 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018510
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000018511 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
18512 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
18513 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
18514 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
18515 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
18516 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
18517 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
18518 prefixed with a '+' sign.
18519
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018520These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
18521protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
18522that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018523due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
18524"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
18525that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018526
18527Most common cases :
18528
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018529 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
18530 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
18531 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
18532 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
18533 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
18534 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
18535 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
18536 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
18537 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
18538 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
18539 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020018540 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018541
18542 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
18543 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
18544 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
18545 of ms on remote networks.
18546
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018547 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
18548 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
18549 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018550
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018551 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
18552 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
18553 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
18554 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
18555 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
18556 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
18557 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
18558 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
18559 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018560
18561Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
18562
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018563 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018564 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018565 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018566
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018567 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018568 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
18569 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
18570
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018571 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018572 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
18573 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
18574 flags.
18575
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018576 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
18577 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018578 Check the session termination flags, then check the
18579 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
18580 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
18581 the client connection was maintained open.
18582
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018583 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018584 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018585 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018586 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
18587
18588
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185898.5. Session state at disconnection
18590-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018591
18592TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
18593"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
185942-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
18595each of which has a special meaning :
18596
18597 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
18598 session to terminate :
18599
18600 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
18601
18602 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
18603 server explicitly refused it.
18604
18605 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
18606 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
18607 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
18608 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018609 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018610
18611 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
18612 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018613
18614 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
18615 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
18616 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
18617 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
18618 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
18619
18620 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
18621 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
18622 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
18623 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
18624 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
18625
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090018626 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
18627 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
18628
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070018629 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
18630 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
18631 backup connections when going up.
18632
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020018633 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
18634
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018635 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
18636 send or receive data.
18637
18638 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
18639 send or receive data.
18640
18641 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
18642 with nothing left in the buffers.
18643
18644 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
18645
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010018646 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018647 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
18648
18649 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
18650 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
18651 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
18652 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
18653 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
18654
18655 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
18656 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
18657
18658 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
18659 server (HTTP only).
18660
18661 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
18662
18663 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
18664 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
18665 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
18666
18667 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
18668 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
18669 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
18670
18671 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
18672
18673 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
18674 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
18675
18676 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
18677 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
18678 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
18679
18680 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
18681 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020018682 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
18683 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018684
18685 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
18686 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
18687 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
18688 another server.
18689
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018690 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018691 server.
18692
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018693 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
18694 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
18695 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
18696 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18697
18698 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
18699 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
18700 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
18701 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18702
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020018703 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
18704 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
18705 "use-server" rule).
18706
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018707 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18708
18709 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
18710 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
18711
18712 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
18713
18714 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
18715 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
18716 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
18717
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018718 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
18719 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018720 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018721 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
18722 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
18723
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018724 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
18725
18726 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
18727 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
18728
18729 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
18730
18731 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18732
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018733The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
18734was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018735helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
18736starvation, attacks, etc...
18737
18738The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
18739alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
18740easier finding and understanding.
18741
18742 Flags Reason
18743
18744 -- Normal termination.
18745
18746 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
18747 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
18748 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
18749 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
18750
18751 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
18752 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
18753 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
18754 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
18755 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
18756 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018757
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018758 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18759 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018760 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018761
18762 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
18763 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
18764 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
18765
18766 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
18767 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
18768 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
18769 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
18770 the server takes too long to respond.
18771
18772 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
18773 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
18774 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
18775 long a time to respond.
18776
18777 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
18778 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
18779 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
18780 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018781 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
18782 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018783
18784 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
18785 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
18786 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
18787 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
18788 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020018789 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018790 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
18791 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
18792 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
18793 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
18794 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
18795 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
18796 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
18797 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018798 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018799 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
18800 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
18801 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018802
18803 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
18804 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018805 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
18806 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
18807 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
18808 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018809
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018810 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
18811 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
18812
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018813 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018814 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
18815 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018816 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018817 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
18818 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
18819
18820 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
18821 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
18822 503 or 504 here.
18823
18824 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
18825 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
18826 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
18827 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
18828 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
18829
18830 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18831 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018832 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018833 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
18834 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
18835
18836 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
18837 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
18838 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
18839 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
18840 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
18841 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
18842 between haproxy and the server.
18843
18844 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
18845 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
18846 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
18847 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
18848 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
18849 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
18850 solution is to fix the application.
18851
18852 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
18853 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
18854 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
18855 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
18856 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
18857 external attacks.
18858
18859 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
18860 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018861 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018862 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
18863 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
18864
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018865 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
18866 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
18867 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018868 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020018869 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018870
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018871 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
18872 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
18873 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
18874 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018875 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
18876 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
18877 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
18878 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
18879 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018880
18881 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
18882 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
18883 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
18884 returned an HTTP 403 error.
18885
18886 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
18887 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
18888 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
18889 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
18890
18891 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
18892 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
18893 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
18894 only be solved by proper system tuning.
18895
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018896The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
18897persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
18898important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
18899re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
18900
18901 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
18902
18903 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18904 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
18905 set on a GET request.
18906
18907 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
18908 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018909 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018910 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
18911
18912 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
18913 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
18914 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
18915
18916 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18917 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
18918 already got a cookie.
18919
18920 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18921 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
18922 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
18923 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
18924 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
18925
18926 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18927 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18928 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18929
18930 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
18931 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18932 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18933
18934 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
18935 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
18936
18937 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
18938 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
18939 then advertised in the response.
18940
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018941
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189428.6. Non-printable characters
18943-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018944
18945In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
18946consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
18947converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
18948prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
18949being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
18950escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
18951is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
18952'}' when logging headers.
18953
18954Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
18955issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
18956containing spaces is "User-Agent".
18957
18958Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
18959the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
18960performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
18961
18962
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189638.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
18964---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018965
18966Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
18967achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018968section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018969cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
18970the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
18971the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018972locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018973not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
18974user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
18975a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
18976wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
18977
18978 Examples :
18979 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
18980 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18981
18982 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18983 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18984
18985
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189868.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18987---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018988
18989Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18990proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18991the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18992server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18993
18994Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18995response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018996section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018997
18998It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018999time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
19000appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019001are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
19002and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
19003follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
19004request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
19005in the logs.
19006
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019007As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
19008frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
19009an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
19010
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019011 Example :
19012 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
19013 listen proxy-out
19014 mode http
19015 option httplog
19016 option logasap
19017 log global
19018 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
19019
19020 # log the name of the virtual server
19021 capture request header Host len 20
19022
19023 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
19024 capture request header Content-Length len 10
19025
19026 # log the beginning of the referrer
19027 capture request header Referer len 20
19028
19029 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
19030 capture response header Server len 20
19031
19032 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
19033 capture response header Content-Length len 10
19034
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019035 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019036 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
19037
19038 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
19039 capture response header Via len 20
19040
19041 # log the URL location during a redirection
19042 capture response header Location len 20
19043
19044 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
19045 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
19046 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19047 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
19048 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
19049
19050 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19051 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19052 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19053 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019054 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019055
19056 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19057 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19058 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19059 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
19060 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019061 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019062
19063
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190648.9. Examples of logs
19065---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019066
19067These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
19068them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
19069reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
19070
19071 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
19072 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
19073 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19074
19075 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
19076 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
19077
19078 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
19079 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
19080 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19081
19082 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
19083 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
19084
19085 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
19086 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
19087 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
19088
19089 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019090 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019091 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
19092 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
19093
19094 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
19095 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
19096 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
19097
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020019098 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
19099 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
19100 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
19101 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
19102 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
19103 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019104
19105 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019106 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019107
19108 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
19109 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
19110 Nothing was sent to any server.
19111
19112 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
19113 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
19114
19115 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
19116 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019117 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019118 send a 408 return code to the client.
19119
19120 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
19121 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
19122
19123 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
19124 5 seconds ("c----").
19125
19126 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
19127 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019128 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019129
19130 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019131 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019132 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
19133 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
19134 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
19135 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
19136 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019137
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020019138
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200191399. Supported filters
19140--------------------
19141
19142Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
19143accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
19144unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
19145
19146See also : "filter"
19147
191489.1. Trace
19149----------
19150
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010019151filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019152
19153 Arguments:
19154 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
19155 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
19156
19157 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
19158 the client and the server. By default, this filter
19159 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
19160 only parses a random amount of the available data.
19161
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019162 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019163 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
19164 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
19165 amount of the parsed data.
19166
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019167 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010019168
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019169This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
19170callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
19171information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
19172filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
19173
19174Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
19175tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
19176a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
19177
19178
191799.2. HTTP compression
19180---------------------
19181
19182filter compression
19183
19184The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
19185keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019186when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
19187fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
19188done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
19189explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
19190filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
19191listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19192order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019193
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019194See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
19195 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019196
19197
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200191989.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
19199--------------------------------------------
19200
19201filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
19202
19203 Arguments :
19204
19205 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
19206 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
19207 parsed.
19208
19209 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
19210 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
19211 part must be placed in its own scope.
19212
19213The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
19214external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019215streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020019216exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
19217also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
19218
19219SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
19220the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
19221
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019222For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020019223"doc/SPOE.txt".
19224
19225Important note:
19226 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
19227 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
19228
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100192299.4. Cache
19230----------
19231
19232filter cache <name>
19233
19234 Arguments :
19235
19236 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
19237
19238The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
19239"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019240cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019241other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
19242case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
19243is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
19244filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010019245listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19246order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010019247
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019248See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
19249 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
19250
19251
192529.5. Fcgi-app
19253-------------
19254
19255filter fcg-app <name>
19256
19257 Arguments :
19258
19259 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
19260
19261The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
19262request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
19263reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
19264used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
19265implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
19266used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
19267fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
19268used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19269order.
19270
19271See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
19272 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
19273
19274
1927510. FastCGI applications
19276-------------------------
19277
19278HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
19279feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
19280the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
19281FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
19282servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
19283FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
19284backend.
19285
19286HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
19287application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
19288connection.
19289
1929010.1. Setup
19291-----------
19292
1929310.1.1. Fcgi-app section
19294--------------------------
19295
19296fcgi-app <name>
19297 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
19298 document root must be defined.
19299
19300acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
19301 Declare or complete an access list.
19302
19303 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
19304 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
19305 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
19306 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
19307 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
19308
19309docroot <path>
19310 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
19311 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
19312 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
19313
19314index <script-name>
19315 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
19316 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
19317 is an optional setting.
19318
19319 Example :
19320 index index.php
19321
19322log-stderr global
19323log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
19324 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
19325 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
19326
19327 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
19328 default STDERR messages are ignored.
19329
19330pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
19331 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
19332 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
19333 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
19334
19335 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
19336 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
19337 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
19338 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
19339
19340 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
19341 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
19342
19343path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019344 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010019345 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
19346 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
19347 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
19348 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
19349 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
19350 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
19351 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019352
19353 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019354 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019355 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
19356 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
19357 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
19358 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019359
19360 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010019361 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
19362 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019363
19364option get-values
19365no option get-values
19366 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
19367
19368 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
19369 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
19370
19371 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
19372 application will accept.
19373
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020019374 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
19375 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019376
19377 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
19378 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
19379 option is disabled.
19380
19381 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
19382 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
19383 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
19384 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
19385 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
19386 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
19387
19388option keep-conn
19389no option keep-conn
19390 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
19391 sending a response.
19392
19393 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
19394 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
19395
19396option max-reqs <reqs>
19397 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
19398 accept.
19399
19400 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
19401 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
19402 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
19403 to 1.
19404
19405option mpxs-conns
19406no option mpxs-conns
19407 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
19408
19409 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
19410 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
19411
19412set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
19413 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
19414 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
19415 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
19416 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
19417
19418 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
19419 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
19420 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
19421
19422 Example :
19423 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
19424 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
19425
19426 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
19427
19428
1942910.1.2. Proxy section
19430---------------------
19431
19432use-fcgi-app <name>
19433 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
19434
19435 Arguments :
19436 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
19437
19438 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
19439 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
19440 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
19441 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
19442 application may be defined at a time per backend.
19443
19444 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
19445 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
19446 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
19447 application are evaluated.
19448
19449
1945010.1.3. Example
19451---------------
19452
19453 frontend front-http
19454 mode http
19455 bind *:80
19456 bind *:
19457
19458 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
19459 default_backend back-static
19460
19461 backend back-static
19462 mode http
19463 server www A.B.C.D:80
19464
19465 backend back-dynamic
19466 mode http
19467 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
19468 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
19469
19470 fcgi-app php-fpm
19471 log-stderr global
19472 option keep-conn
19473
19474 docroot /var/www/my-app
19475 index index.php
19476 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
19477
19478
1947910.2. Default parameters
19480------------------------
19481
19482A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
19483the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019484script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019485applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
19486
19487 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19488 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
19489 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
19490 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
19491 | | |
19492 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19493 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
19494 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
19495 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
19496 | | application. |
19497 | | |
19498 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19499 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
19500 | | the request. It may not be set. |
19501 | | |
19502 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19503 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
19504 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
19505 | | the application's configuration. |
19506 | | |
19507 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19508 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
19509 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
19510 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
19511 | | |
19512 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19513 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
19514 | | following the part that identifies the script |
19515 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
19516 | | be defined. |
19517 | | |
19518 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19519 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
19520 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
19521 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
19522 | | is not set too. |
19523 | | |
19524 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19525 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
19526 | | set. |
19527 | | |
19528 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19529 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
19530 | | the request. |
19531 | | |
19532 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19533 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
19534 | | client as part of user authentication. |
19535 | | |
19536 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19537 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
19538 | | script to process the request. |
19539 | | |
19540 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19541 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
19542 | | |
19543 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19544 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
19545 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
19546 | | |
19547 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19548 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
19549 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
19550 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
19551 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
19552 | | |
19553 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19554 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
19555 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
19556 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
19557 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
19558 | | side. |
19559 | | |
19560 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19561 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
19562 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
19563 | | connected to. |
19564 | | |
19565 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19566 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
19567 | | |
19568 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19569 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
19570 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
19571 | | |
19572 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19573
19574
1957510.3. Limitations
19576------------------
19577
19578The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
19579way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
19580during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
19581establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
19582application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
19583or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
19584message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
19585these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
19586and HTTP servers under the same backend.
19587
19588Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
19589request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
19590requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
19591
19592About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
19593into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
19594fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
19595"http-request" ones.
19596
19597Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
19598FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
19599processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
19600must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
19601here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010019602
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019603/*
19604 * Local variables:
19605 * fill-column: 79
19606 * End:
19607 */